blob: faaf290b79d1c1e911eaf6c35f4d051a8af668d3 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau50bdda62015-07-22 17:32:56 +02007 2015/07/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020053
544. Proxies
554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
564.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
57
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200585. Bind and Server options
595.1. Bind options
605.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200615.3. Server DNS resolution
625.3.1. Global overview
635.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064
656. HTTP header manipulation
66
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
687.1. ACL basics
697.1.1. Matching booleans
707.1.2. Matching integers
717.1.3. Matching strings
727.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
737.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
757.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
767.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200777.3.1. Converters
787.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
817.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084
858. Logging
868.1. Log levels
878.2. Log formats
888.2.1. Default log format
898.2.2. TCP log format
908.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100918.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100928.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200938.3. Advanced logging options
948.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
958.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
968.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
978.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
988.4. Timing events
998.5. Session state at disconnection
1008.6. Non-printable characters
1018.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1028.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1038.9. Examples of logs
104
1059. Statistics and monitoring
1069.1. CSV format
1079.2. Unix Socket commands
108
109
1101. Quick reminder about HTTP
111----------------------------
112
113When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
114fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
115on almost anything found in the contents.
116
117However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
118formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
119correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
120
121
1221.1. The HTTP transaction model
123-------------------------------
124
125The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100126to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
128connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
129will involve a new connection :
130
131 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
132
133In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
134establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
135by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
136length.
137
138Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
139to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
140however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
141response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
142header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
143
144 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
145
146Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
147power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
148but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
151A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
152keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
153second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
154page :
155
156 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
157
158This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
159latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
160correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
161the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100162server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
165connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
166leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
167start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100169HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
170 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
171 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
172 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
173 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
174 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
175 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
1781.2. HTTP request
179-----------------
180
181First, let's consider this HTTP request :
182
183 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100184 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
186 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
187 3 User-agent: my small browser
188 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
189 5 Accept: image/png
190
191
1921.2.1. The Request line
193-----------------------
194
195Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
196
197 - a METHOD : GET
198 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
199 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
200
201All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
202which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
203followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
204is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
205desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
206the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
207
208The URI itself can have several forms :
209
210 - A "relative URI" :
211
212 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
213
214 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
215 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
216
217 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
218
219 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220
221 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
222 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
223 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
224 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
225 must accept this form too.
226
227 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
228 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
229 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
232 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
233 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
234 other protocols too.
235
236In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
237mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
238on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
239It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
240specific to the language, framework or application in use.
241
242
2431.2.2. The request headers
244--------------------------
245
246The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
247beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
248an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
249Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
250values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
251encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
252the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
253define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
254
255Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
256their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
257"Connection:" header).
258
259The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
260that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
261is one valid form of empty line.
262
263Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
264headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
265about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
266application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
267
268Important note:
269 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
270 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
271 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
272 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
273
274
2751.3. HTTP response
276------------------
277
278An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
279messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
280
281 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100282 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200283 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
284 2 Content-length: 350
285 3 Content-Type: text/html
286
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200287As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
288codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
289response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100290continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
291the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
292following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
293sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
294(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
295correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
296such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
297state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
298over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
299if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
300information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302
3031.3.1. The Response line
304------------------------
305
306Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
307
308 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
309 - a status code : 200
310 - a reason : OK
311
312The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200313 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200314 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
315 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
316 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
317 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
318
319Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
322messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
323or "Authentication Required".
324
325Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
326
327 Code When / reason
328 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
329 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100332 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334 400 for an invalid or too large request
335 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
336 accessing the stats page)
337 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
338 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
339 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
340 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
341 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
342 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
343 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
344 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
345 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
346
347The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3484.2).
349
350
3511.3.2. The response headers
352---------------------------
353
354Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
355the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
356details.
357
358
3592. Configuring HAProxy
360----------------------
361
3622.1. Configuration file format
363------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200364
365HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
366
367 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
368 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
369 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
370 "frontend" and "backend".
371
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
373referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200374delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003772.2. Quoting and escaping
378-------------------------
379
380HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
381many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
382with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
383single quotes.
384
385If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
386them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
387escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
388
389Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
390
391 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
392 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
393 \\ to use a backslash
394 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
395 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
396
397Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
398the interpretation of:
399
400 space as a parameter separator
401 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
402 # hash as a comment start
403
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200404Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
405-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
406backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
407
408Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200409quoting.
410
411Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
412nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
413
414Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
415equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
416
417 Example:
418 # those are equivalents:
419 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
421 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
424
425 # those are equivalents:
426 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
427 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
430
431
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004322.3. Environment variables
433--------------------------
434
435HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
436interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
437configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
438optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
439shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
440underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
441
442 Example:
443
444 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
445
446 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
447
448 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
449
450
4512.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200452----------------
453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100454Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100455values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
456otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
457numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
458for every keyword. Supported units are :
459
460 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
461 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
462 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
463 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
464 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
465 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
466
467
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004682.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200469-------------
470
471 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
472 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
473 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
474 global
475 daemon
476 maxconn 256
477
478 defaults
479 mode http
480 timeout connect 5000ms
481 timeout client 50000ms
482 timeout server 50000ms
483
484 frontend http-in
485 bind *:80
486 default_backend servers
487
488 backend servers
489 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
490
491
492 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
493 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
494 global
495 daemon
496 maxconn 256
497
498 defaults
499 mode http
500 timeout connect 5000ms
501 timeout client 50000ms
502 timeout server 50000ms
503
504 listen http-in
505 bind *:80
506 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
507
508
509Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
510
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100511 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200512
513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005143. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515--------------------
516
517Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
518are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
519of them have command-line equivalents.
520
521The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
522
523 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200524 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900528 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - gid
530 - group
531 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100532 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200533 - nbproc
534 - pidfile
535 - uid
536 - ulimit-n
537 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200538 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100539 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200540 - node
541 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100542 - unix-bind
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100543 - 51degrees-data-file
544 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200545 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200546 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100547
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200549 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200551 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100552 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100553 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100554 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200555 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200556 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200557 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558 - noepoll
559 - nokqueue
560 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100561 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300562 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200563 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200564 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200565 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100566 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100567 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200568 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100569 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100570 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100571 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100572 - tune.lua.session-timeout
573 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100574 - tune.maxaccept
575 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200576 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200577 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200578 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100579 - tune.rcvbuf.client
580 - tune.rcvbuf.server
581 - tune.sndbuf.client
582 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100583 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100584 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200585 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100586 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200587 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200588 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200589 - tune.vars.global-max-size
590 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
591 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
592 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100593 - tune.zlib.memlevel
594 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100595
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200596 * Debugging
597 - debug
598 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599
600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006013.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602------------------------------------
603
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200604ca-base <dir>
605 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200606 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
607 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200608
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609chroot <jail dir>
610 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
611 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
612 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
613 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
614 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
615 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100616
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100617cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
618 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
619 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
620 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100621 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
622 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
623 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
624 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
625 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
626 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
627 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
628 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
629 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
630 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100631
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200632crt-base <dir>
633 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
634 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
635 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
636
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637daemon
638 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
639 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
640 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
641
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200642deviceatlas-json-file <path>
643 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
644 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
645
646deviceatlas-log-level <value>
647 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
648 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
649
650deviceatlas-separator <char>
651 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
652 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
653
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900654external-check
655 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
656 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
657 See "option external-check".
658
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200659gid <number>
660 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
661 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
662 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100663 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
664 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200665 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100666
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200667group <group name>
668 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
669 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100670
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200671log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
673 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100674 configured with "log global".
675
676 <address> can be one of:
677
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100678 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100679 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
680 port).
681
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100682 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
683 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
684 port).
685
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100686 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
687 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
688 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
689 writeable).
690
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200691 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
692 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100693
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200694 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
695 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
696 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
697 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
698 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
699 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
700 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
701 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
702 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
703 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
704 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
705
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100706 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200707
708 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
709 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
710 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
711
712 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200713 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
714 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
715 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
716 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
717 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
718 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200720 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100722log-send-hostname [<string>]
723 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
724 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
725 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
726 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
727 the logs.
728
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000729log-tag <string>
730 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
731 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
732 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100733 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000734
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100735lua-load <file>
736 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
737 used multiple times.
738
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200739nbproc <number>
740 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
741 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
742 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
743 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
744 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
745
746pidfile <pidfile>
747 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
748 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
749 starting the process. See also "daemon".
750
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100751stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200752 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
753 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
754 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
755 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
756 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
757 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100758 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200759 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
760 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200761
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100762ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
763 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
764 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300765 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100766 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
767 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
768 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
769 "bind" keyword for more information.
770
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100771ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
772 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
773 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
774 keyword to see available options.
775
776 Example:
777 global
778 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
779
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100780ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
781 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
782 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300783 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100784 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
785 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
786 information.
787
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100788ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
790 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
791 keyword to see available options.
792
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200793ssl-dh-param-file <file>
794 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
795 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
796 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
797 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
798 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
799 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them directly
800 in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size specified
801 by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are known to be
802 more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
803 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
804 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
805 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
806
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100807ssl-server-verify [none|required]
808 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
809 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
810 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
811
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200812stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
813 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
814 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
815 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
816 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200817
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200818 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
819 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
820 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200821
822stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
823 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
824 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100825 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200826
827stats maxconn <connections>
828 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
829 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
830
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200831uid <number>
832 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
833 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
834 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
835 one. See also "gid" and "user".
836
837ulimit-n <number>
838 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
839 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
840 option.
841
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100842unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
843 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
844
845 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
846 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
847 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
848 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
849 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
850 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
851 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
852 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
853 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
854 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
855
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200856user <user name>
857 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
858 See also "uid" and "group".
859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200860node <name>
861 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
862
863 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
864 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
865 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
866 traffic.
867
868description <text>
869 Add a text that describes the instance.
870
871 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
872 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
873 "<" and ">" characters.
874
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010087551degrees-data-file <file path>
876 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
877 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
878
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200879 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100880 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
881
88251degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
883 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
884 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
885 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
886
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200887 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100888 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
889
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020089051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100891 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
892 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
893
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200894 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
895 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
896
89751degrees-cache-size <number>
898 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
899 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
900 By default, this cache is disabled.
901
902 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100903 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
904
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009063.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200907-----------------------
908
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200909max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
910 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
911 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
912 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
913 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
914 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
915 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
916 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
917 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
918
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919maxconn <number>
920 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
921 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
922 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200923 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
924 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
925 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
926 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100927 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
928 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
929 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
930 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
931 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200933maxconnrate <number>
934 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
935 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
936 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
937 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
938 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
939 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
940 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
941 fairness.
942
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100943maxcomprate <number>
944 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300945 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100946 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
947 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
948 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
949 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
950 default value.
951
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100952maxcompcpuusage <number>
953 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
954 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
955 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
956 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
957 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
958 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
959 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
960 process down and from introducing high latencies.
961
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100962maxpipes <number>
963 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
964 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
965 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
966 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
967 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
968 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
969
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200970maxsessrate <number>
971 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
972 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
973 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
974 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
975 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
976 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
977 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
978 fairness.
979
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200980maxsslconn <number>
981 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
982 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
983 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
984 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
985 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
986 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
987 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100988 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
989 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
990 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
991 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
992 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
993 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
994 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200995
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200996maxsslrate <number>
997 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
998 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
999 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1000 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1001 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1002 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1003 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1004 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1005 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1006 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1007
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001008maxzlibmem <number>
1009 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1010 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1011 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001012 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1013 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1014 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1015
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016noepoll
1017 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1018 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001019 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020
1021nokqueue
1022 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1023 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1024 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1025
1026nopoll
1027 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1028 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001029 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001030 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001031
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001032nosplice
1033 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1034 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1035 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001036 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001037 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1038 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1039 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1040 "option splice-response".
1041
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001042nogetaddrinfo
1043 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1044 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1045
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001046spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001047 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1048 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1049 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1050 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1051 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1052 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001053
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001054tune.buffers.limit <number>
1055 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1056 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1057 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1058 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1059 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1060 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1061 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1062 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1063 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1064 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1065 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1066 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1067 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1068 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1069 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1070
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001071tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1072 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1073 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1074 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1075 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1076
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001077tune.bufsize <number>
1078 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1079 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1080 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1081 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1082 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1083 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1084 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1085 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001086 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1087 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1088 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001089
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001090tune.chksize <number>
1091 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1092 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1093 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1094 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1095 checks whenever possible.
1096
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001097tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1098 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1099 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1100 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1101 this value. The default value is 1.
1102
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001103tune.http.cookielen <number>
1104 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1105 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1106 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1107 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1108 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1109 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1110 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1111 to change this value.
1112
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001113tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1114 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1115 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1116 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1117 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1118 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1119 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1120 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1121 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1122 limit too high.
1123
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001124tune.idletimer <timeout>
1125 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1126 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1127 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1128 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1129 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1130 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1131 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1132 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1133 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1134
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001135tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1136 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1137 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1138 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1139 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1140 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1141 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1142 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1143
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001144tune.lua.maxmem
1145 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1146 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1147 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1148 memory.
1149
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001150tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1151 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1152 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1153 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1154 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1155 4s.
1156
1157tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1158 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1159 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1160 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1161 check servers.
1162
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001163tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001164 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1165 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1166 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1167 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1168 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1169 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1170 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1171 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1172 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1173 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001174
1175tune.maxpollevents <number>
1176 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1177 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1178 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1179 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1180 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1181
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001182tune.maxrewrite <number>
1183 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1184 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1185 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1186 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1187 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1188 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1189 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1190 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1191 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1192 bufsize.
1193
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001194tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1195 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1196 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1197 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1198 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1199 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1200 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1201 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1202 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1203 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1204 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1205 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1206 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1207 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1208 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1209 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1210 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1211 setting this parameter to 0.
1212
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001213tune.pipesize <number>
1214 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1215 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1216 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1217 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1218 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1219 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1220
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001221tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1222tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1223 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1224 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1225 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1226 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1227 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1228 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1229 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1230
1231tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1232tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1233 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1234 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1235 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1236 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1237 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1238 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1239 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1240 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1241 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1242 notifying haproxy again.
1243
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001244tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001245 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1246 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1247 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001248 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001249 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1250 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1251 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1252 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1253 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001254 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1255 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001256
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001257tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1258 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1259 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1260 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1261 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1262 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1263 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1264
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001265tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1266 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001267 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001268 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1269 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1270 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1271 being used for too long.
1272
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001273tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1274 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1275 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1276 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1277 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1278 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1279 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1280 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1281 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1282 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1283 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001284 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1285 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001286
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001287tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1288 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1289 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1290 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1291 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1292 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1293 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1294 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001295 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1296 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001297
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001298tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1299 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1300 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1301 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1302 1000 entries.
1303
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001304tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1305tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1306tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1307tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
1308 These four tunes helps to manage the allowed amount of memory used by the
1309 variables system. "global" limits the memory for all the systems. "sess" limit
1310 the memory by session, "txn" limits the memory by transaction and "reqres"
1311 limits the memory for each request or response processing. during the
1312 accounting, "sess" embbed "txn" and "txn" embed "reqres".
1313
1314 By example, we considers that "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is fixed to 100,
1315 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" is fixed to 100, "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" is
1316 also fixed to 100. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1317 we cannot create any more variable in the other contexts.
1318
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001319tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1320 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001321 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001322 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1323 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1324 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1325
1326tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1327 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1328 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1329 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1330 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013323.3. Debugging
1333--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001334
1335debug
1336 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1337 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1338 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1339 system startup.
1340
1341quiet
1342 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1343 line argument "-q".
1344
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013463.4. Userlists
1347--------------
1348It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1349http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1350it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1351
1352userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001353 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001354 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1355
1356group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001357 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001358 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1359 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1360
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001361user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1362 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001363 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1364 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001365 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1366 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001367 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001368 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001369
1370
1371 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001372 userlist L1
1373 group G1 users tiger,scott
1374 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001375
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001376 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1377 user scott insecure-password elgato
1378 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001379
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001380 userlist L2
1381 group G1
1382 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001383
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001384 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1385 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1386 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001387
1388 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001389
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001390
13913.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001392----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001393It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1394several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1395instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1396values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1397automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1398In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1399using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1400tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1401reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1402Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1403that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1404each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001405
1406peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001407 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001408 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1409
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001410disabled
1411 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1412 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1413 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1414
1415enable
1416 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1417
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001418peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1419 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1420 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1421 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1422 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1423 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1424 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1425
1426 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1427 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1428
1429 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1430 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1431 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1432 across all peers.
1433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001434 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1435 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001436
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001437 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001438 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001439 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1440 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1441 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001442
1443 backend mybackend
1444 mode tcp
1445 balance roundrobin
1446 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1447 stick on src
1448
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001449 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1450 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001451
1452
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090014533.6. Mailers
1454------------
1455It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1456If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1457in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1458
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001459mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001460 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1461 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1462
1463mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1464 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1465
1466 Example:
1467 mailers mymailers
1468 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1469 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1470
1471 backend mybackend
1472 mode tcp
1473 balance roundrobin
1474
1475 email-alert mailers mymailers
1476 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1477 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1478
1479 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1480 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1481
1482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014834. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001484----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001485
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001486Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001487 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001488 - frontend <name>
1489 - backend <name>
1490 - listen <name>
1491
1492A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1493its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1494section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001495section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001496
1497A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1498connections.
1499
1500A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1501to forward incoming connections.
1502
1503A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1504parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001506All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1507'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1508case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1509
1510Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1511logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1512proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1513However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1514name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1515
1516Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1517and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001518bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001519protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1520modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1521arbitrary criteria.
1522
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001523In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1524a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1525the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1526
1527 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1528 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1529 between responses and new requests.
1530
1531 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1532 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1533 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1534 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1535
1536 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1537 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1538 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1539
1540 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1541 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1542 client-facing connection remains open.
1543
1544 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1545 after the end of the response.
1546
1547The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1548frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1549following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1550weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1551
1552 Backend mode
1553
1554 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1555 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1556 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1557 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1558 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1559 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1560 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1561 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1562 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1563 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1564 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001566
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015684.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1569--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001571The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1572limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1573they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1574limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001575marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001576option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001577and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1578with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1579specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001580
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001581
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001582 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1583------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1584acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001585appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001586backlog X X X -
1587balance X - X X
1588bind - X X -
1589bind-process X X X X
1590block - X X X
1591capture cookie - X X -
1592capture request header - X X -
1593capture response header - X X -
1594clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001595compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001596contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1597cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001598declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001599default-server X - X X
1600default_backend X X X -
1601description - X X X
1602disabled X X X X
1603dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001604email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001605email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001606email-alert mailers X X X X
1607email-alert myhostname X X X X
1608email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001609enabled X X X X
1610errorfile X X X X
1611errorloc X X X X
1612errorloc302 X X X X
1613-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1614errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001615force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001616fullconn X - X X
1617grace X X X X
1618hash-type X - X X
1619http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001620http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001621http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001622http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001623http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001624http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001625http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001626id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001627ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001628log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001629log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001630log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001631max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001632maxconn X X X -
1633mode X X X X
1634monitor fail - X X -
1635monitor-net X X X -
1636monitor-uri X X X -
1637option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1638option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1639option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1640option allbackups (*) X - X X
1641option checkcache (*) X - X X
1642option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1643option contstats (*) X X X -
1644option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1645option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1646option forceclose (*) X X X X
1647-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1648option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001649option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001650option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001651option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001652option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001653option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001654option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001655option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001656option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1657option httpchk X - X X
1658option httpclose (*) X X X X
1659option httplog X X X X
1660option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001661option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001662option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001663option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001664option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1665option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1666option logasap (*) X X X -
1667option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001668option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001669option nolinger (*) X X X X
1670option originalto X X X X
1671option persist (*) X - X X
1672option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001673option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001674option smtpchk X - X X
1675option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1676option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1677option splice-request (*) X X X X
1678option splice-response (*) X X X X
1679option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1680option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1681-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001682option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001683option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1684option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1685option tcpka X X X X
1686option tcplog X X X X
1687option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001688external-check command X - X X
1689external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001690persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1691rate-limit sessions X X X -
1692redirect - X X X
1693redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1694redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1695reqadd - X X X
1696reqallow - X X X
1697reqdel - X X X
1698reqdeny - X X X
1699reqiallow - X X X
1700reqidel - X X X
1701reqideny - X X X
1702reqipass - X X X
1703reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001704reqitarpit - X X X
1705reqpass - X X X
1706reqrep - X X X
1707-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001708reqtarpit - X X X
1709retries X - X X
1710rspadd - X X X
1711rspdel - X X X
1712rspdeny - X X X
1713rspidel - X X X
1714rspideny - X X X
1715rspirep - X X X
1716rsprep - X X X
1717server - - X X
1718source X - X X
1719srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001720stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001721stats auth X - X X
1722stats enable X - X X
1723stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001724stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001725stats realm X - X X
1726stats refresh X - X X
1727stats scope X - X X
1728stats show-desc X - X X
1729stats show-legends X - X X
1730stats show-node X - X X
1731stats uri X - X X
1732-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1733stick match - - X X
1734stick on - - X X
1735stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001736stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001737stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001738tcp-check connect - - X X
1739tcp-check expect - - X X
1740tcp-check send - - X X
1741tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001742tcp-request connection - X X -
1743tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001744tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001745tcp-response content - - X X
1746tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001747timeout check X - X X
1748timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001749timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001750timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1751timeout connect X - X X
1752timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1753timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1754timeout http-request X X X X
1755timeout queue X - X X
1756timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001757timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001758timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1759timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001760timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001761transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001762unique-id-format X X X -
1763unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001764use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001765use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001766------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1767 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017704.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1771---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001772
1773This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1774
1775
1776acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1777 Declare or complete an access list.
1778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1779 no | yes | yes | yes
1780 Example:
1781 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1782 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1783 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001785 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786
1787
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001788appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1789 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1792 no | no | yes | yes
1793 Arguments :
1794 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1795 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1796
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001797 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798 checked in each cookie value.
1799
1800 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1801 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1802 milliseconds.
1803
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001804 request-learn
1805 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1806 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1807 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1808 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1809 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1810 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1811
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001812 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1813 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1814 data following this prefix.
1815
1816 Example :
1817 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1818
1819 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1820 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1821
1822 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1823 2 modes are currently supported :
1824 - path-parameters :
1825 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1826 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1827 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1828 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1829 - query-string :
1830 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1831 query string.
1832
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001833 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1834 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1835 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001836
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001837 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1838 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001839
1840
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001841backlog <conns>
1842 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1844 yes | yes | yes | no
1845 Arguments :
1846 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1847 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001848 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001849
1850 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1851 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1852 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1853 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1854 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1855 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1856 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1857 backlog parameter.
1858
1859 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1860 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1861 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1862
1863 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1864
1865
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001866balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001867balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001868 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1870 yes | no | yes | yes
1871 Arguments :
1872 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1873 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1874 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1875 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1876
1877 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1878 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1879 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1880 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001881 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001882 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001883 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1884 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1885 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1886 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1887 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1888 it, so that you don't worry.
1889
1890 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1891 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1892 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1893 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1894 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1895 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1896 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1897 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001898
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001899 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1900 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1901 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1902 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1903 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1904 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1905 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1906 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1907
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001908 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001909 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001910 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1911 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001912 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001913 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1914 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1915 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1916 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1917 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001918 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1919 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1920 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1921 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1922 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1923 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001925 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1926 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1927 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1928 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1929 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1930 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1931 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1932 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001933 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001934 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001935 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1936 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1937 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001938
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001939 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1940 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1941 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1942 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1943 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1944 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1945 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1946 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1947 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1948 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1949 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1950 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001951
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001952 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001953 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1954 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1955 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1956 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1957 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1958 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1959 URIs start with a leading "/".
1960
1961 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1962 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1963 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1964 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1965
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001966 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001967 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1968
1969 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001970 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1971 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001972 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1973 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1974 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1975 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001976 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001977 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1978 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001979
1980 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1981 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1982 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1983 server will receive the request.
1984
1985 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1986 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1987 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1988 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1989 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001990 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1991 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1992 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001994 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1995 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1996 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1997 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1998 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002000 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002001 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2002 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2003 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2004
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002005 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2006 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2007 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2008
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002009 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002010 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002011 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2012 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2013 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2014 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2015 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2016 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002017 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002018 used instead.
2019
2020 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2021 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2022 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2023 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2024
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002025 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2026 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2027 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2028
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002029 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002030
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002031 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002032 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2033 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002034
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002035 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2036 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2037 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038
2039 Examples :
2040 balance roundrobin
2041 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002042 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002043 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2044 balance hdr(host)
2045 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002046
2047 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2048 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002050 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002051 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2052 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2053 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2054 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2055
2056 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2057 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2058 defaults to 16 kB.
2059
2060 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2061 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2062
2063 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2064 Round Robin.
2065
2066 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2067 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2068 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2069 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2070
2071 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2072
2073 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002074 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002075 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2076 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2077 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002079 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002080
2081
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002082bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2083bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2086 no | yes | yes | no
2087 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002088 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2089 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2090 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2091 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002092 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002093 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2094 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2095 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2096 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2097 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2098 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2099 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002100 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2101 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2102 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2103 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2104 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2105 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2106 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002107 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2108 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2109 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002110 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2111 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2112 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002113
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002114 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2115 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002116 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2117 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2118 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002119 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2120 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2121 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2122 the range.
2123
2124 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2125 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2126 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2127 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2128 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2129 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2130 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002131 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002132 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002133
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002134 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2135 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2136 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2137 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2138 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2139 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2140 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2141 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2142
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002143 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2144 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2145 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2146 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002147
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002148 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2149 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2150 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2151 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2152 in a frontend.
2153
2154 Example :
2155 listen http_proxy
2156 bind :80,:443
2157 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002158 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002159
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002160 listen http_https_proxy
2161 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002162 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002163
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002164 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2165 bind ipv6@:80
2166 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2167 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2168
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002169 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002170 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002171
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002172 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002173 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002174
2175
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002176bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002177 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2179 yes | yes | yes | yes
2180 Arguments :
2181 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2182 may be used to override a default value.
2183
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002184 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002185 option may be combined with other numbers.
2186
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002187 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002188 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2189 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2190 missing from all processes.
2191
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002192 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002193 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002194 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2195 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2196 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2197 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002198
2199 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2200 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2201 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2202 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2203 and 'even' instances.
2204
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002205 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2206 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2207 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2208 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002209
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002210 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2211 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2212
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002213 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2214 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2215 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2216
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002217 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2218 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2219
2220 Example :
2221 listen app_ip1
2222 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002223 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002224
2225 listen app_ip2
2226 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002227 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002228
2229 listen management
2230 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002231 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002232
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002233 listen management
2234 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2235 bind-process 1-4
2236
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002237 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002238
2239
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002240block { if | unless } <condition>
2241 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2243 no | yes | yes | yes
2244
2245 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2246 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002247 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002248 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002249 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2250 "block" statements per instance.
2251
2252 Example:
2253 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2254 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2255 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2256 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002258 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002259
2260
2261capture cookie <name> len <length>
2262 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2264 no | yes | yes | no
2265 Arguments :
2266 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2267 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2268 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2269 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2270 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2271
2272 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2273 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2274 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2275 right if it exceeds <length>.
2276
2277 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2278 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2279 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2280 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2281
2282 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2283 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2284 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2285
2286 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2287 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2288 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002289 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2290 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2291 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002292
2293 Example:
2294 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2295
2296 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002297 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002298
2299
2300capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002301 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2303 no | yes | yes | no
2304 Arguments :
2305 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002306 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2308 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2309 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2310
2311 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2312 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2313 it exceeds <length>.
2314
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002315 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002316 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2317 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002318 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2319 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2320 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2321 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002322 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002323 environments to find where the request came from.
2324
2325 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2326 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2327 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2328 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002329
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002330 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2331 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2332 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2333 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2334 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002335
2336 Example:
2337 capture request header Host len 15
2338 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2339 capture request header Referrer len 15
2340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002341 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342 about logging.
2343
2344
2345capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002346 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2348 no | yes | yes | no
2349 Arguments :
2350 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002351 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2353 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2354 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2355
2356 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2357 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2358 it exceeds <length>.
2359
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002360 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002361 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2362 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2363 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002364 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2365 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2366 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2367 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002368
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002369 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2370 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2371 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2372 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2373 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002374
2375 Example:
2376 capture response header Content-length len 9
2377 capture response header Location len 15
2378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002379 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380 about logging.
2381
2382
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002383clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002384 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2386 yes | yes | yes | no
2387 Arguments :
2388 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2389 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2390 as explained at the top of this document.
2391
2392 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2393 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2394 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2395 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2396 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2397 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2398 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2399 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002400 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2402 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2403
2404 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2405 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2406 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2407 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2408 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2409 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2410
2411 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2412 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2413
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002414 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2415 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002416
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002417compression algo <algorithm> ...
2418compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002419compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002420 Enable HTTP compression.
2421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2422 yes | yes | yes | yes
2423 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002424 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2425 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2426 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2427
2428 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002429 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2430 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2431 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002432
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002433 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2434 support for zlib was built in.
2435
2436 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2437 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2438 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2439 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2440 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2441 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002442
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002443 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2444 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2445 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2446 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2447 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2448 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2449 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2450 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002451
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002452 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002453 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002454 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2455 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2456 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2457 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2458 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002459
2460 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2461 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2462 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2463 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2464 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002465 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2466 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2467 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2468 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2469 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002470 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2471 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002472
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002473 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002474 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2475 "Accept-Encoding" header
2476 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002477 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002478 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2479 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002480 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2481 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2482 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2483 "multipart"
2484 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2485 header
2486 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2487 and later
2488 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2489 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002490
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002491 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2492 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002493
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002494 Examples :
2495 compression algo gzip
2496 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002497
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002498contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2501 yes | no | yes | yes
2502 Arguments :
2503 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2504 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2505 as explained at the top of this document.
2506
2507 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002508 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002509 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2511 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2512 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2513 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2514
2515 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2516 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2517 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2518 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2519 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2520 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2521
2522 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2523 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2524 instead.
2525
2526 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2527 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2528
2529
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002530cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002531 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2532 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2535 yes | no | yes | yes
2536 Arguments :
2537 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2538 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2539 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2540 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2541 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2542 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2543 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2544 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2545 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2546
2547 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2548 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2549 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2550 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2551 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2552 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2553 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2554 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2555 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2556 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2557 "insert" and "prefix".
2558
2559 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002560 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002561
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002562 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002563 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2564 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2565 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2566 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2567 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2568 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2569 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2570 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2571 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2572 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002573
2574 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2575 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2576 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2577 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2578 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2579 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2580 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2581 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2582 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2583 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002584 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2585 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2586 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002587
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002588 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2589 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2590 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002591 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2592 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2593 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2594 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002595 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2596 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2597 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002598
2599 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2600 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2601 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2602 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2603 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2604 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2605 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2606 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2607 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2608
2609 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2610 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2611 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2612 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2613 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2614 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2615 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2616 persistence cookie in the cache.
2617 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2618
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002619 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2620 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2621 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2622 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2623 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2624 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2625 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2626 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2627 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2628 they logout.
2629
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002630 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2631 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2632 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2633 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2634
2635 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2636 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2637 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2638 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2639 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2640 this attribute.
2641
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002642 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002643 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002644 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2645 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2646 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2647 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2648 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2649 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002650
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002651 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2652 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2653 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2654 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2655 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2656 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2657 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2658 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2659 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2660 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2661 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2662 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2663 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2664 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2665 the site.
2666
2667 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2668 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2669 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2670 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2671 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2672 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2673 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2674 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2675 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2676 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2677 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2678 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2679 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2680 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2681 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2682 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002684 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2685 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2686 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2687 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002688
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002689 Examples :
2690 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2691 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2692 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002693 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002694
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002695 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002696
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002697
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002698declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2699 Declares a capture slot.
2700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2701 no | yes | yes | no
2702 Arguments:
2703 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2704
2705 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2706 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2707 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2708 for use in the response.
2709
2710 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
2711 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2712
2713
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002714default-server [param*]
2715 Change default options for a server in a backend
2716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2717 yes | no | yes | yes
2718 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002719 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2720 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2721 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2722 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002723
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002724 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002725 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2726
2727 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002728
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002729
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002730default_backend <backend>
2731 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2733 yes | yes | yes | no
2734 Arguments :
2735 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2736
2737 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2738 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2739 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2740 will catch all undetermined requests.
2741
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002742 Example :
2743
2744 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2745 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2746 default_backend dynamic
2747
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002748 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002749
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002750
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002751description <string>
2752 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2754 no | yes | yes | yes
2755 Arguments : string
2756
2757 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2758 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2759 it describes.
2760 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2761
2762
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763disabled
2764 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2766 yes | yes | yes | yes
2767 Arguments : none
2768
2769 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2770 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2771 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2772 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2773 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2774 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2775 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2776
2777 See also : "enabled"
2778
2779
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002780dispatch <address>:<port>
2781 Set a default server address
2782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2783 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002784 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002785
2786 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2787 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2788 during start-up.
2789
2790 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2791 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2792 possible with normal servers.
2793
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002794 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002795 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2796 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2797 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2798 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2799
2800 See also : "server"
2801
2802
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002803enabled
2804 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2806 yes | yes | yes | yes
2807 Arguments : none
2808
2809 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2810 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2811
2812 See also : "disabled"
2813
2814
2815errorfile <code> <file>
2816 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2818 yes | yes | yes | yes
2819 Arguments :
2820 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002821 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2822 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823
2824 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002825 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002826 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002827 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2828 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002829
2830 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2831 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2832 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2833
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002834 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2835
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002836 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2837 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2838 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2839 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2840
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002841 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2842 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2843 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2844 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2845 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2846 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2847
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002848 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2849 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2850 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002851 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002852 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2853
2854 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2855
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002856 Example :
2857 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002858 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002859 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2860 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2861
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002862
2863errorloc <code> <url>
2864errorloc302 <code> <url>
2865 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2867 yes | yes | yes | yes
2868 Arguments :
2869 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002870 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002871
2872 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2873 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2874 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2875 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2876 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2877
2878 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2879 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2880 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2881
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002882 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2883
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002884 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2885 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2886 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2887 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2888 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2889 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2890 request.
2891
2892 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2893
2894
2895errorloc303 <code> <url>
2896 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2898 yes | yes | yes | yes
2899 Arguments :
2900 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2901 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2902
2903 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2904 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2905 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2906 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2907 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2908
2909 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2910 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2911 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2912
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002913 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2914
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002915 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2916 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2917 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2918 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002919 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002920
2921 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2922
2923
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002924email-alert from <emailaddr>
2925 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2926 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2928 yes | yes | yes | yes
2929
2930 Arguments :
2931
2932 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2933
2934 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2935 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2936
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002937 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2938 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2939
2940
2941email-alert level <level>
2942 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2943 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2944 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2945 yes | yes | yes | yes
2946
2947 Arguments :
2948
2949 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2950 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2951 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2952
2953 By default level is alert
2954
2955 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2956 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2957 for the proxy.
2958
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002959 Alerts are sent when :
2960
2961 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2962 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2963 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2964 is notice or lower
2965 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2966 and a health check status update occurs
2967
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002968 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2969 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002970 section 3.6 about mailers.
2971
2972
2973email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2974 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2975 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2976 yes | yes | yes | yes
2977
2978 Arguments :
2979
2980 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2981
2982 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2983 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2984
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002985 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2986 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002987
2988
2989email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2990 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2991 mailers.
2992 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2993 yes | yes | yes | yes
2994
2995 Arguments :
2996
2997 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2998
2999 By default the systems hostname is used.
3000
3001 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3002 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3003 for the proxy.
3004
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003005 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3006 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003007
3008
3009email-alert to <emailaddr>
3010 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3011 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3012 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3013 yes | yes | yes | yes
3014
3015 Arguments :
3016
3017 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3018
3019 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3020 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3021
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003022 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003023 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3024
3025
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003026force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3027 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3029 no | yes | yes | yes
3030
3031 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3032 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3033 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3034 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3035 marked down for maintenance operations.
3036
3037 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3038 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3039 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3040 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3041 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3042 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3043 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3044 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3045 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3046
3047 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3048 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3049 is used.
3050
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003051 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003052 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003053
3054
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003055fullconn <conns>
3056 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3058 yes | no | yes | yes
3059 Arguments :
3060 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3061 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3062
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003063 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003064 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003065 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003066 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3067 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3068 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3069 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3070 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003071 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003072
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003073 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3074 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003075 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3076 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3077 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003078
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003079 Example :
3080 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3081 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3082 # connections.
3083 backend dynamic
3084 fullconn 10000
3085 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3086 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3087
3088 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3089
3090
3091grace <time>
3092 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003094 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003095 Arguments :
3096 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3097 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3098 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3099
3100 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3101 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003102 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003103 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3104
3105 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3106 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3107 simplify it.
3108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003109
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003110hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003111 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3113 yes | no | yes | yes
3114 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003115 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3116 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003117
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003118 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3119 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3120 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3121 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3122 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3123 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3124 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3125 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3126 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3127 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003128
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003129 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3130 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3131 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3132 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3133 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3134 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3135 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3136 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3137 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3138 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3139 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3140 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3141 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003142 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3143 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003144
3145 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3146
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003147 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003148 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3149 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3150 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003151 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3152 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3153 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003154
3155 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3156 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003157 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3158 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3159 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3160 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3161
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003162 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3163 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3164 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3165 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3166 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3167 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3168 parameter.
3169
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003170 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3171 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3172 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3173 used on strings.
3174
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003175 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3176
3177 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3178 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3179 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3180 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3181 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3182 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3183 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3184 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3185 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3186 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3187 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3188 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003189
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003190 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3191 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3192 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003193
3194 See also : "balance", "server"
3195
3196
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003197http-check disable-on-404
3198 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003200 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003201 Arguments : none
3202
3203 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3204 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3205 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3206 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3207 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3208 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3209 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3210 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003211 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3212 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3213 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3214
3215 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3216
3217
3218http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003219 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003221 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003222 Arguments :
3223 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3224 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003225 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003226 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3227 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3228 details on the supported keywords.
3229
3230 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3231 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3232 with the usual backslash ('\').
3233
3234 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3235 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3236 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3237 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3238 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3239
3240 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003241 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003242 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3243 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3244 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3245
3246 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003247 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003248 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3249 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3250 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3251 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3252
3253 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003254 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003255 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3256 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3257 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3258 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3259 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3260 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3261 trace).
3262
3263 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003264 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003265 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3266 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3267 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3268 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3269 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3270 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3271
3272 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3273 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3274 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3275 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3276 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3277 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3278 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3279 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3280
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003281 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3282 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3283 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3284
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003285 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3286 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3287
3288 Examples :
3289 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003290 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003291
3292 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003293 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003294
3295 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003296 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003297
3298 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003299 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003301 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003302
3303
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003304http-check send-state
3305 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3307 yes | no | yes | yes
3308 Arguments : none
3309
3310 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3311 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3312 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3313 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3314 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3315
3316 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3317 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3318 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3319 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3320 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003321 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3322 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3323 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3324
3325 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3326 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3327 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3328
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003329 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3330 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3331 checked in multiple backends.
3332
3333 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3334 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3335
3336 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3337 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3338 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3339 one fails.
3340
3341 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3342 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3343 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3344
3345 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3346 server's queue.
3347
3348 Example of a header received by the application server :
3349 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3350 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3351
3352 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3353
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003354http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003355 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003356 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003357 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003358 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3359 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003360 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3361 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003362 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3363 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3364 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003365 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003366 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003367 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003368 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003369 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003370 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003371 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003372 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003373 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3374
3375 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3376 no | yes | yes | yes
3377
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003378 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3379 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3380 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3381 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3382 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003383
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003384 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3385 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3386 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3387
3388 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3389 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3390 are evaluated.
3391
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003392 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3393 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3394 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3395 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3396 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3397 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3398 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3399 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3400 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003401 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003402 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3403
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003404 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3405 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3406 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3407 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3408 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3409
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003410 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3411 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3412 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003413 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3414 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003415
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003416 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3417 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3418 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3419 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3420 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3421 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3422 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3423 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3424
3425 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3426 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3427 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003428 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3429 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003430
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003431 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3432 <name>.
3433
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003434 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3435 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3436 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3437 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3438 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3439 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3440 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3441 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3442
3443 Example:
3444
3445 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3446
3447 applied to:
3448
3449 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3450
3451 outputs:
3452
3453 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3454
3455 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3456
3457 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3458 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3459 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3460 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3461 header.
3462
3463 Example:
3464
3465 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3466
3467 applied to:
3468
3469 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3470
3471 outputs:
3472
3473 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3474
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003475 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3476 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3477 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3478 it.
3479
3480 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3481 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3482 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3483 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3484 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3485 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3486
3487 Example :
3488 # prepend the host name before the path
3489 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3490
3491 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3492 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3493 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3494 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3495 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3496 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3497 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3498 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3499
3500 Example :
3501 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3502 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3503
3504 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3505 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3506 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3507 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3508 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3509 "set-query".
3510
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003511 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3512 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3513 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3514 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3515 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3516 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3517 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3518 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3519
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003520 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3521 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3522 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3523 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3524 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3525 another equipment.
3526
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003527 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3528 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3529 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3530 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3531 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3532 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3533 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3534 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3535
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003536 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3537 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3538 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3539 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3540 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3541 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3542 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3543 admin privileges.
3544
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003545 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3546 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3547 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3548 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3549 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3550 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3551 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3552 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3553
3554 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3555 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3556 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3557 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3558 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3559 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3560
3561 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3562 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3563 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3564 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3565 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3566 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3567
3568 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3569 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3570 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3571 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3572 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3573 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3574 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3575 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3576 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3577
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003578 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003579 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3580 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3581 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3582 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3583 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3584 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3585 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3586 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3587 request header" for more information.
3588
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003589 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3590 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3591 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3592 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
3593
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003594 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3595 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3596 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3597 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3598 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3599 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3600 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3601 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3602 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3603 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3604 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3605 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3606
3607 These actions take one or two arguments :
3608 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3609 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3610 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3611 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3612
3613 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3614 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3615 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3616 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3617
3618 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3619 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3620 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3621 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3622 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3623 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3624 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3625 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3626
3627 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3628 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3629 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3630 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3631 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3632
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003633 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3634 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3635 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3636 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3637 continues.
3638
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003639 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3640 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3641 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3642 the actions evaluation continues.
3643
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003644 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3645 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3646 function is documented in the API documentation.
3647
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003648 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3649 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3650 inline.
3651
3652 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3653 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3654 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3655 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3656 (request and response)
3657 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3658 processing
3659 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3660 processing.
3661 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3662 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3663 and '_'.
3664
3665 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3666 followed by some converters.
3667
3668 Example:
3669
3670 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3671
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003672 - set-src <expr> :
3673 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3674 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3675 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3676 source IP for privacy.
3677
3678 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3679 followed by some converters.
3680
3681 Example:
3682
3683 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3684 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3685
3686 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3687
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003688 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3689
3690 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3691 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3692 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3693 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003694
3695 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003696 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3697 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3698 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003699
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003700 http-request allow if nagios
3701 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3702 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3703 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003704
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003705 Example:
3706 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003707 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003708
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003709 Example:
3710 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3711 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3712 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3713 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3714 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3715 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3716 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3717 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3718 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3719
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003720 Example:
3721 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3722 acl add path /addacl
3723 acl del path /delacl
3724
3725 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3726
3727 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3728 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3729
3730 Example:
3731 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3732 acl setmap path /setmap
3733 acl delmap path /delmap
3734
3735 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3736
3737 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3738 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3739
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003740 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3741 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003742
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003743http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003744 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003745 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003746 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3747 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003748 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3749 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3750 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3751 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003752 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003753 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003754 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003755 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003756 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003757 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003758 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003759 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3760
3761 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3762 no | yes | yes | yes
3763
3764 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3765 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3766 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3767 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3768 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3769 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3770
3771 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3772 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3773 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3774 current section.
3775
3776 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3777 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3778 rules are evaluated.
3779
3780 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3781 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3782 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3783 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3784 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3785 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3786 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3787
3788 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3789 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3790 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3791 external users.
3792
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003793 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3794 <name>.
3795
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003796 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3797 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3798 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3799 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3800 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3801 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3802 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3803 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3804
3805 Example:
3806
3807 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3808
3809 applied to:
3810
3811 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3812
3813 outputs:
3814
3815 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3816
3817 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3818
3819 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3820 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3821 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3822 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3823 header.
3824
3825 Example:
3826
3827 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3828
3829 applied to:
3830
3831 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3832
3833 outputs:
3834
3835 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3836
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003837 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3838 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3839 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3840 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3841 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3842 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3843 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3844 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3845
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003846 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3847 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3848 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3849 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3850 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3851 another equipment.
3852
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003853 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3854 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3855 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3856 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3857 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3858 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3859 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3860 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3861
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003862 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3863 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3864 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3865 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3866 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3867 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3868 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3869 admin privileges.
3870
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003871 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3872 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3873 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3874 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3875 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3876 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3877 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3878 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3879
3880 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3881 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3882 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3883 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3884 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3885 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3886
3887 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3888 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3889 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3890 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3891 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3892 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3893
3894 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3895 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3896 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3897 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3898 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3899 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3900 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3901 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3902 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3903
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003904 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3905 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3906 function is documented in the API documentation.
3907
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02003908 - capture <sample> id <id> :
3909 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
3910 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
3911 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
3912 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
3913 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
3914 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3915 response header" for more information.
3916
3917 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
3918 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
3919 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
3920 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
3921 keyword.
3922
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003923 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3924 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
3925 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
3926 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
3927 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
3928 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
3929
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003930 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
3931 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3932 inline.
3933
3934 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3935 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3936 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3937 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3938 (request and response)
3939 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3940 processing
3941 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3942 processing.
3943 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3944 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3945 and '_'.
3946
3947 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3948 followed by some converters.
3949
3950 Example:
3951
3952 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
3953
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003954 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3955 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3956 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3957 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3958 continues.
3959
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003960 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3961 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3962 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3963 the actions evaluation continues.
3964
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003965 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3966
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003967 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003968 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3969 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3970 rules.
3971
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003972 Example:
3973 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3974
3975 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3976
3977 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3978 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3979
3980 Example:
3981 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3982
3983 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3984
3985 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3986 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3987
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003988 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3989 ACL usage.
3990
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003991
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003992http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
3993 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
3994
3995 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 yes | no | yes | yes
3997
3998 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
3999 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4000 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4001 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4002 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4003 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4004
4005 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4006
4007 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4008 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4009 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4010 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4011 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4012 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4013 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4014 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4015 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4016 not checking any request past the first one.
4017
4018 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4019 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4020 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4021 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4022 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4023 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4024 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4025
4026 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4027 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4028 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4029 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4030 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4031 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4032 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4033 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4034 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4035 downsides of rare connection failures.
4036
4037 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4038 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4039 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4040 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4041 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4042 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4043 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4044 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4045 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4046 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4047 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4048 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4049
4050 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4051 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4052 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4053 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4054
4055 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4056 and are never shared ;
4057
4058 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4059 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4060 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4061 and are never shared ;
4062
4063 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4064 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4065 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4066
4067 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4068 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4069 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4070
4071 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4072
4073
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004074http-send-name-header [<header>]
4075 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4076
4077 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4078 yes | no | yes | yes
4079
4080 Arguments :
4081
4082 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4083
4084 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4085 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4086 is added with the header string proved.
4087
4088 See also : "server"
4089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004090id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004091 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4093 no | yes | yes | yes
4094 Arguments : none
4095
4096 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4097 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4098 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004099
4100
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004101ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4102 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4103 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4104 no | yes | yes | yes
4105
4106 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4107 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4108 and running).
4109
4110 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4111 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4112 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004113 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004114 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4115
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004116 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4117 "unless" condition is met.
4118
4119 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4120
4121
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004122log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004123log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004124no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004125 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4127 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004128
4129 Prefix :
4130 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4131 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4132 prefix does not allow arguments.
4133
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004134 Arguments :
4135 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4136 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4137 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4138 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4139 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4140 parameter.
4141
4142 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4143 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4144
4145 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4146 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4147 standard syslog port).
4148
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004149 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4150 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4151 standard syslog port).
4152
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004153 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4154 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4155 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4156 appropriately writeable).
4157
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004158 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4159 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004160
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004161 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4162 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4163 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4164 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4165 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4166 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4167 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4168 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4169 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4170 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4171 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4172
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004173 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4174
4175 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4176 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4177 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4178
4179 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4180 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4181 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004182 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4183 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4184 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4185 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4186 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004187
4188 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4189
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004190 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4191 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4192 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004193
4194 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4195 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4196 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4197 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4198
4199 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4200 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004201
4202 Example :
4203 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004204 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4205 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004206 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004207
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004208
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004209log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004210 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4211 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4212 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004213
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004214 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4215 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4216 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4217 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4218 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004219
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004220log-tag <string>
4221 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4222 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4223 yes | yes | yes | yes
4224
4225 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4226 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4227 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4228 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4229 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4230 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4231 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4232 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4233 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004234
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004235max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4236 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4237 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4238 yes | no | yes | yes
4239
4240 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4241 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4242 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4243 servers.
4244
4245 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4246 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4247 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4248 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4249 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4250 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4251 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4252 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4253 picking a different server.
4254
4255 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4256 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4257 even if they have to be queued.
4258
4259 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4260 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4261
4262
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004263maxconn <conns>
4264 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4266 yes | yes | yes | no
4267 Arguments :
4268 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4269 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4270 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4271 closes.
4272
4273 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4274 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4275 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4276 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4277 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4278 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4279 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4280 properly tuned.
4281
4282 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4283 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4284 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4285
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004286 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4287
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004288 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4289
4290
4291mode { tcp|http|health }
4292 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4294 yes | yes | yes | yes
4295 Arguments :
4296 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4297 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4298 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4299 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4300
4301 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4302 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4303 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4304 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4305 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4306
4307 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004308 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4309 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4310 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4311 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4312 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4313 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4314 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004315
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004316 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4317 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4318 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004319
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004320 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004321 defaults http_instances
4322 mode http
4323
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004324 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004325
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004326
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004327monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004328 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4330 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004331 Arguments :
4332 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4333 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004334 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004335 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4336 backend and its backup.
4337
4338 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4339 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4340 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4341 servers in a list of backends.
4342
4343 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4344 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4345 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4346 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4347 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4348 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4349 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004350 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4351 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004352
4353 Example:
4354 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004355 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004356 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4357 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4358 monitor-uri /site_alive
4359 monitor fail if site_dead
4360
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004361 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004362
4363
4364monitor-net <source>
4365 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4367 yes | yes | yes | no
4368 Arguments :
4369 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4370 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4371 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4372 followed by a mask.
4373
4374 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4375 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004376 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004377 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4378
4379 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4380 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4381 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4382 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004383 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4384 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4385 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004386
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004387 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4388 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4389 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4390 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4391 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4392 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004393
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004394 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4395 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004396
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004397 Example :
4398 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4399 frontend www
4400 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4401
4402 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4403
4404
4405monitor-uri <uri>
4406 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4408 yes | yes | yes | no
4409 Arguments :
4410 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4411 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4412
4413 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4414 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4415 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4416 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4417 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4418 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4419 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4420 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4421
4422 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4423 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4424 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4425 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4426 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4427 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4428
4429 Example :
4430 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4431 frontend www
4432 mode http
4433 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4434
4435 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4436
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004437
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004438option abortonclose
4439no option abortonclose
4440 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4442 yes | no | yes | yes
4443 Arguments : none
4444
4445 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4446 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4447 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4448 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004449 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004450 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4451 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4452 encountered while delivering the response.
4453
4454 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4455 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4456 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4457 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4458 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4459 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004460 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004461 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004462 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004463 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4464 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4465 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4466
4467 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4468 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4469 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4470 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4471 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4472 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4473 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4474 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004475 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004476
4477 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4478 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4479
4480 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4481
4482
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004483option accept-invalid-http-request
4484no option accept-invalid-http-request
4485 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4487 yes | yes | yes | no
4488 Arguments : none
4489
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004490 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004491 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4492 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4493 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4494 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4495 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4496 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4497 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004498 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4499 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4500 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4501 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4502 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004503 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004504 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4505 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4506 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004507
4508 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4509 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4510 been confirmed.
4511
4512 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4513 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004514 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4515 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004516 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4517
4518 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4519 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4520
4521 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4522 stats socket.
4523
4524
4525option accept-invalid-http-response
4526no option accept-invalid-http-response
4527 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4529 yes | no | yes | yes
4530 Arguments : none
4531
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004532 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004533 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4534 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4535 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4536 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4537 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4538 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4539 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004540 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4541 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4542 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004543
4544 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4545 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4546 been confirmed.
4547
4548 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4549 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4550 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4551 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4552
4553 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4554 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4555
4556 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4557 stats socket.
4558
4559
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004560option allbackups
4561no option allbackups
4562 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4564 yes | no | yes | yes
4565 Arguments : none
4566
4567 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4568 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4569 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4570 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4571 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4572 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4573 order between the backup servers anymore.
4574
4575 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4576 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4577
4578 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4579 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4580
4581
4582option checkcache
4583no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004584 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4586 yes | no | yes | yes
4587 Arguments : none
4588
4589 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4590 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004591 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004592 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4593 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004594 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004595
4596 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004597 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004598 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004599 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4600 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004601 to the client are :
4602 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004603 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004604 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004605 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4606 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4607 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4608 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4609 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4610 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4611 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4612 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4613 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4614 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4615 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4616
4617 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004618 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004619 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004620 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004621 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4622
4623 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4624 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004625 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004626 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4627
4628 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4629 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4630
4631
4632option clitcpka
4633no option clitcpka
4634 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4636 yes | yes | yes | no
4637 Arguments : none
4638
4639 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4640 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4641 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4642 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4643
4644 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4645 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4646 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4647 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4648
4649 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4650 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4651 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4652 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4653 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4654
4655 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4656
4657 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4658 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4659 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4660
4661 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4662 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4663
4664 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4665
4666
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004667option contstats
4668 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4670 yes | yes | yes | no
4671 Arguments : none
4672
4673 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4674 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4675 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4676 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4677 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4678 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4679 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4680
4681
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004682option dontlog-normal
4683no option dontlog-normal
4684 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4686 yes | yes | yes | no
4687 Arguments : none
4688
4689 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4690 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4691 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4692 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4693 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4694 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4695 logged.
4696
4697 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4698 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4699 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004701 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004702 logging.
4703
4704
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004705option dontlognull
4706no option dontlognull
4707 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4709 yes | yes | yes | no
4710 Arguments : none
4711
4712 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4713 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4714 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4715 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4716 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4717 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004718 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4719 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4720 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004721
4722 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4723 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4724 would not be logged.
4725
4726 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4727 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4728
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004729 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4730 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004731
4732
4733option forceclose
4734no option forceclose
4735 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004737 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004738 Arguments : none
4739
4740 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4741 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4742 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4743 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4744 global session times in the logs.
4745
4746 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004747 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004748 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004749
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004750 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4751 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4752 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4753
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004754 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4755 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004756
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004757 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4758 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4759
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004760 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004761
4762
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004763option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004764 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4766 yes | yes | yes | yes
4767 Arguments :
4768 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4769 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004770 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004771 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004772
4773 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4774 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4775 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4776 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4777 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4778 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4779 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004780 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4781 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4782 possible that the client has already brought one.
4783
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004784 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004785 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004786 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4787 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004788 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4789 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004790
4791 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4792 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4793 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4794 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4795 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4796 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4797 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4798
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004799 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4800 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4801 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4802 are under the control of the end-user.
4803
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004804 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004805 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4806 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004807 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4808 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4809 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004810
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004811 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004812 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4813 frontend www
4814 mode http
4815 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4816
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004817 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4818 backend www
4819 mode http
4820 option forwardfor header X-Client
4821
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004822 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004823 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004824
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004825
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004826option http-buffer-request
4827no option http-buffer-request
4828 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
4829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4830 yes | yes | yes | yes
4831 Arguments : none
4832
4833 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
4834 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
4835 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
4836 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
4837 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
4838 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
4839 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
4840 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
4841 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
4842 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
4843 default.
4844
4845 See also : "option http-no-delay"
4846
4847
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004848option http-ignore-probes
4849no option http-ignore-probes
4850 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4852 yes | yes | yes | no
4853 Arguments : none
4854
4855 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4856 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4857 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4858 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4859 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4860 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4861 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4862 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4863 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4864 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4865 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4866 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4867
4868 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4869 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4870 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4871 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4872 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4873 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4874 are often the only way to detect them.
4875
4876 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4877 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4878
4879 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4880
4881
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004882option http-keep-alive
4883no option http-keep-alive
4884 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4886 yes | yes | yes | yes
4887 Arguments : none
4888
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004889 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4890 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4891 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4892 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4893 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4894 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4895 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4896
4897 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4898 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004899 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4900 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4901 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4902 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4903 situations where this option may be useful :
4904
4905 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4906 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4907
4908 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4909 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4910
4911 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4912 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4913 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4914 request.
4915
4916 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4917 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004918 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4919 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4920 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004921
4922 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4923 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4924
4925 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4926 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4927 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4928 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4929 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4930 not set.
4931
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004932 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4933 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004934 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004935 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004936
4937 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004938 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4939 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004940
4941
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004942option http-no-delay
4943no option http-no-delay
4944 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4946 yes | yes | yes | yes
4947 Arguments : none
4948
4949 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4950 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4951 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4952 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4953 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4954 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4955 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4956 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4957 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4958 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4959 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4960 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4961 affected.
4962
4963 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4964 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4965 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4966 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4967 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4968 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4969 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4970 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4971 latency environments.
4972
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004973 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
4974
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004975
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004976option http-pretend-keepalive
4977no option http-pretend-keepalive
4978 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4980 yes | yes | yes | yes
4981 Arguments : none
4982
4983 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4984 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4985 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4986 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4987 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4988 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4989 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4990 consider the response complete.
4991
4992 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4993 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4994 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4995 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4996 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4997 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4998
4999 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5000 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5001 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5002 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5003 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5004 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5005 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5006
5007 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5008 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005009 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005010 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5011 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005012
5013 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5014 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5015
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005016 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5017 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005018
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005019
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005020option http-server-close
5021no option http-server-close
5022 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5024 yes | yes | yes | yes
5025 Arguments : none
5026
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005027 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5028 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5029 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5030 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5031 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5032 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5033 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5034 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5035 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5036 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5037 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5038 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5039 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5040 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5041 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5042 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005043
5044 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5045 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5046 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5047 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005048 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5049 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005050
5051 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5052 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005053 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5054 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005055 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5056 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005057
5058 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5059 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5060
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005061 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005062 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5063 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005064
5065
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005066option http-tunnel
5067no option http-tunnel
5068 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5070 yes | yes | yes | yes
5071 Arguments : none
5072
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005073 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5074 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5075 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5076 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5077 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5078 "option http-tunnel".
5079
5080 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005081 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005082 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5083 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5084 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5085 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5086 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5087 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5088 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005089
5090 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5091 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5092
5093 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5094 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5095 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5096
5097
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005098option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005099no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005100 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5102 yes | yes | yes | no
5103 Arguments : none
5104
5105 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5106 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5107 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5108 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5109 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5110 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5111 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5112
5113 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5114 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
5115 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
5116 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
5117 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
5118 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
5119 request along its whole life.
5120
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005121 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5122 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5123 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5124 front of an existing proxy.
5125
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005126 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5127
5128 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5129 http-server-close".
5130
5131
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005132option httpchk
5133option httpchk <uri>
5134option httpchk <method> <uri>
5135option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5136 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5138 yes | no | yes | yes
5139 Arguments :
5140 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5141 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5142 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5143 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5144 ones.
5145
5146 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5147 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5148 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5149
5150 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5151 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5152 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5153 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5154 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5155
5156 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5157 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5158 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5159 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5160 the lack of any response.
5161
5162 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5163
5164 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5165 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5166 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5167
5168 Examples :
5169 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5170 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5171 backend https_relay
5172 mode tcp
5173 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5174 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5175
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005176 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5177 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5178 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005179
5180
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005181option httpclose
5182no option httpclose
5183 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5185 yes | yes | yes | yes
5186 Arguments : none
5187
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005188 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5189 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5190 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5191 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005192 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005193 "option http-tunnel".
5194
5195 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5196 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5197 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5198 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5199 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5200 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5201 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5202 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005203
5204 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005205 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005206 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5207 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5208 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5209 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5210 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005211
5212 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5213 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005214 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5215 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005216 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5217 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005218
5219 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5220 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5221
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005222 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5223 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005224
5225
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005226option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005227 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5229 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005230 Arguments :
5231 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5232 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5233 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5234 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5235 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005236
5237 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5238 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5239 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5240 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5241 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5242 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5243 ports.
5244
5245 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5246
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005247 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5248 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005250 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005251
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005252
5253option http_proxy
5254no option http_proxy
5255 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5257 yes | yes | yes | yes
5258 Arguments : none
5259
5260 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5261 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5262 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5263 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5264 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5265
5266 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5267 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
5268 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
5269 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01005270 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005271 be analyzed.
5272
5273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5275
5276 Example :
5277 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5278 backend direct_forward
5279 option httpclose
5280 option http_proxy
5281
5282 See also : "option httpclose"
5283
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005284
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005285option independent-streams
5286no option independent-streams
5287 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5289 yes | yes | yes | yes
5290 Arguments : none
5291
5292 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5293 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5294 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5295 receive data or not.
5296
5297 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5298 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5299 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5300 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5301 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5302 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5303 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5304 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5305 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5306 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5307 socket buffers.
5308
5309 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5310 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5311 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5312 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5313 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5314
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005315 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005316 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5317 deprecated.
5318
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005319 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005320
5321
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005322option ldap-check
5323 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5325 yes | no | yes | yes
5326 Arguments : none
5327
5328 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5329 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5330 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5331 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5332
5333 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5334 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5335
5336 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5337 configure it.
5338
5339 Example :
5340 option ldap-check
5341
5342 See also : "option httpchk"
5343
5344
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005345option external-check
5346 Use external processes for server health checks
5347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5348 yes | no | yes | yes
5349
5350 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5351 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5352 command".
5353
5354 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5355
5356 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5357
5358
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005359option log-health-checks
5360no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005361 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5363 yes | no | yes | yes
5364 Arguments : none
5365
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005366 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5367 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5368 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005369
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005370 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5371 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5372 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5373 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5374 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5375
5376 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5377 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005378
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005379 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5380 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5381 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005382
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005383
5384option log-separate-errors
5385no option log-separate-errors
5386 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5388 yes | yes | yes | no
5389 Arguments : none
5390
5391 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5392 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5393 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5394 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5395 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5396 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5397 provides very important information.
5398
5399 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5400 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5401 error logs.
5402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005403 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005404 logging.
5405
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005406
5407option logasap
5408no option logasap
5409 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5411 yes | yes | yes | no
5412 Arguments : none
5413
5414 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5415 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5416 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5417 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5418 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5419 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5420 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005421 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005422 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5423 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5424
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005425 Examples :
5426 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5427 mode http
5428 option httplog
5429 option logasap
5430 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5431
5432 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5433 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5434 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5435 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005437 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005438 logging.
5439
5440
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005441option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005442 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5444 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005445 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005446 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5447 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005448 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005449
5450 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5451 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5452 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5453 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5454 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5455 in the MySQL table, like this :
5456
5457 USE mysql;
5458 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5459 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5460
5461 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5462 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5463 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5464 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5465 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5466 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5467 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5468 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5469 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5470
5471 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5472 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005473
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005474 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005475
5476 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5477 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5478 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5479 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005480 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5481 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005482
5483 See also: "option httpchk"
5484
5485
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005486option nolinger
5487no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005488 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005489 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5490 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005491 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005492
5493 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5494 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5495 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5496 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5497 connections.
5498
5499 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5500 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5501 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5502 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5503 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5504 this too.
5505
5506 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5507 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5508 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5509
5510 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5511 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5512 for servers.
5513
5514 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5515 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5516
5517
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005518option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5519 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5521 yes | yes | yes | yes
5522 Arguments :
5523 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5524 matching <network>
5525 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5526 header name.
5527
5528 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5529 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5530 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5531 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5532 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5533 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5534 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5535 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5536 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5537 possible that the client has already brought one.
5538
5539 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5540 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5541 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5542 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5543 header and requires different one.
5544
5545 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5546 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5547 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5548 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5549 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5550 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5551 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5552
5553 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5554 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5555 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5556 both are defined.
5557
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005558 Examples :
5559 # Original Destination address
5560 frontend www
5561 mode http
5562 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5563
5564 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5565 backend www
5566 mode http
5567 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5568
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005569 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5570 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005571
5572
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005573option persist
5574no option persist
5575 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5577 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005578 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005579
5580 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5581 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5582 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5583 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5584 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5585 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5586 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5587 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5588 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5589 redirected to another valid server.
5590
5591 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5592 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5593
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005594 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005595
5596
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005597option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5598 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5600 yes | no | yes | yes
5601 Arguments :
5602 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5603 PostgreSQL server.
5604
5605 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5606 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5607 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5608 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5609
5610 See also: "option httpchk"
5611
5612
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005613option prefer-last-server
5614no option prefer-last-server
5615 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5616 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5617 yes | no | yes | yes
5618 Arguments : none
5619
5620 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5621 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5622 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5623 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5624 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5625 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5626 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5627 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5628 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005629 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5630 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5631 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5632 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5633 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5634 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5635 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005636
5637 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5638 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5639
5640 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5641
5642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005643option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005644option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005645no option redispatch
5646 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5648 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005649 Arguments :
5650 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5651 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5652 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5653 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5654 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5655 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5656 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5657 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5658 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005660
5661 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5662 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5663 be able to access the service anymore.
5664
5665 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5666 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5667
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005668 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005669 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5670 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005672 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5673 "redisp" keywords.
5674
5675 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5676 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5677
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005678 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005679
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005680
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005681option redis-check
5682 Use redis health checks for server testing
5683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5684 yes | no | yes | yes
5685 Arguments : none
5686
5687 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5688 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5689 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5690 find the "+PONG" response message.
5691
5692 Example :
5693 option redis-check
5694
5695 See also : "option httpchk"
5696
5697
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005698option smtpchk
5699option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5700 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5702 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005703 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005704 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5705 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5706 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5707
5708 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5709 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5710 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5711
5712 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5713 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5714 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5715 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5716 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5717 dead server.
5718
5719 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5720 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5721 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5722 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5723
5724 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5725 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5726 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5727 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005728 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005729
5730 Example :
5731 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5732
5733 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005736option socket-stats
5737no option socket-stats
5738
5739 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5741 yes | yes | yes | no
5742
5743 Arguments : none
5744
5745
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005746option splice-auto
5747no option splice-auto
5748 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5750 yes | yes | yes | yes
5751 Arguments : none
5752
5753 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5754 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5755 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5756 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005757 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005758 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5759 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5760 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5761 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5762
5763 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5764 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5765 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5766 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5767 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5768 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5769 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5770 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5771 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5772 keyword.
5773
5774 Example :
5775 option splice-auto
5776
5777 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5778 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5779
5780 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5781 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5782
5783
5784option splice-request
5785no option splice-request
5786 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5788 yes | yes | yes | yes
5789 Arguments : none
5790
5791 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005792 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005793 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5794 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5795 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5796 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5797
5798 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5799
5800 Example :
5801 option splice-request
5802
5803 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5804 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5805
5806 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5807 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5808
5809
5810option splice-response
5811no option splice-response
5812 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5814 yes | yes | yes | yes
5815 Arguments : none
5816
5817 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005818 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005819 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5820 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5821 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5822 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5823
5824 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5825
5826 Example :
5827 option splice-response
5828
5829 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5830 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5831
5832 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5833 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5834
5835
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005836option srvtcpka
5837no option srvtcpka
5838 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5840 yes | no | yes | yes
5841 Arguments : none
5842
5843 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5844 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5845 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5846 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5847
5848 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5849 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5850 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5851 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5852
5853 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5854 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5855 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5856 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5857 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5858
5859 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5860
5861 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5862 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5863 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5864
5865 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5866 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5867
5868 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5869
5870
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005871option ssl-hello-chk
5872 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5874 yes | no | yes | yes
5875 Arguments : none
5876
5877 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5878 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5879 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5880 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5881 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5882 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5883 hello message.
5884
5885 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5886 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5887 messages, which is appreciable.
5888
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005889 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5890 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5891 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005892
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005893 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5894
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005895
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005896option tcp-check
5897 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5898 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5899 yes | no | yes | yes
5900
5901 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5902 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5903
5904 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5905 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5906 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5907
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005908 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005909 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5910 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5911 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5912 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5913 only.
5914
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005915 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005916 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5917 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5918 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5919 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5920
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005921 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005922 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5923 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005924 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005925 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5926 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5927 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5928 the respective protocols.
5929 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5930 analysed.
5931
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005932 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
5933 script.
5934
5935 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
5936 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
5937 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
5938 The "comment" is of course optional.
5939
5940
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005941 Examples :
5942 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5943 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005944 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005945
5946 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5947 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005948 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005949
5950 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5951 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005952 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005953 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005954 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005955 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02005956 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005957 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005958 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5959 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005960 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005961 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5962 tcp-check expect string +OK
5963
5964 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5965 (send many headers before analyzing)
5966 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005967 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005968 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5969 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5970 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5971 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02005972 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005973
5974
5975 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5976
5977
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005978option tcp-smart-accept
5979no option tcp-smart-accept
5980 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5982 yes | yes | yes | no
5983 Arguments : none
5984
5985 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5986 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5987 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5988 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5989 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5990 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5991
5992 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5993 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5994 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5995 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5996
5997 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5998 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5999 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6000 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6001
6002 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6003 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6004 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6005
6006 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6007 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6008 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6009
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006010 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6011
6012
6013option tcp-smart-connect
6014no option tcp-smart-connect
6015 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6017 yes | no | yes | yes
6018 Arguments : none
6019
6020 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6021 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6022 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6023 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6024 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6025
6026 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6027 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6028 complex.
6029
6030 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6031 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6032 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6033
6034 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6035 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6036
6037 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6038
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006039
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006040option tcpka
6041 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6043 yes | yes | yes | yes
6044 Arguments : none
6045
6046 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6047 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6048 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6049 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6050
6051 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6052 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6053 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6054 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6055
6056 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6057 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6058 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6059 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6060 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6061
6062 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6063
6064 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6065 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6066 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6067 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6068 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6069 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6070 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6071 backends.
6072
6073 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6074
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006075
6076option tcplog
6077 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6079 yes | yes | yes | yes
6080 Arguments : none
6081
6082 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6083 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6084 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6085 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6086 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6087 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6088 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6089 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6090
6091 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006093 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006094
6095
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006096option transparent
6097no option transparent
6098 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006100 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006101 Arguments : none
6102
6103 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6104 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6105 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6106 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6107 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6108 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6109 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6110 appropriate server.
6111
6112 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6113 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6114
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006115 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006116 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006117
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006118
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006119external-check command <command>
6120 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6122 yes | no | yes | yes
6123
6124 Arguments :
6125 <command> is the external command to run
6126
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006127 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6128
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006129 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006130
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006131 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6132 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6133 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6134 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6135 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6136 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006137
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006138 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6139
6140 Environment variables :
6141 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6142 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6143
6144 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6145
6146 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6147
6148 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6149 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6150 for a UNIX socket).
6151
6152 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6153
6154 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6155
6156 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6157
6158 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6159
6160 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6161
6162 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6163 socket).
6164
6165 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6166 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6167
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006168 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6169 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6170 failed.
6171
6172 Example :
6173 external-check command /bin/true
6174
6175 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6176
6177
6178external-check path <path>
6179 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6181 yes | no | yes | yes
6182
6183 Arguments :
6184 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6185
6186 The default path is "".
6187
6188 Example :
6189 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6190
6191 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6192 "external-check command"
6193
6194
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006195persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006196persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006197 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6199 yes | no | yes | yes
6200 Arguments :
6201 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006202 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6203 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006204
6205 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6206 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6207 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6208 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6209 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6210 forwarded to this server.
6211
6212 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6213 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6214 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006215 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006216 a single "listen" section.
6217
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006218 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6219 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6220 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6221
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006222 Example :
6223 listen tse-farm
6224 bind :3389
6225 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6226 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6227 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6228 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6229 persist rdp-cookie
6230 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006231 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006232 balance rdp-cookie
6233 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6234 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6235
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006236 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6237 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006238
6239
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006240rate-limit sessions <rate>
6241 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6243 yes | yes | yes | no
6244 Arguments :
6245 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6246 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6247
6248 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6249 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6250 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6251 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6252 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6253 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6254
6255 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6256 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6257 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6258 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6259
6260 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6261 listen smtp
6262 mode tcp
6263 bind :25
6264 rate-limit sessions 10
6265 server 127.0.0.1:1025
6266
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006267 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6268 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6269 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006270
6271 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6272
6273
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006274redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6275redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6276redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006277 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6279 no | yes | yes | yes
6280
6281 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006282 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006283
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006284 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006285 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006286 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6287 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6288 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006289
6290 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6291 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6292 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6293 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6294 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006295 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6296 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6297 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6298 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006299
6300 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6301 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6302 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6303 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6304 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6305 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006306 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006307 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006308 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6309 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6310 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006311
6312 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006313 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6314 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6315 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006316 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006317 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6318 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6319 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6320 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006321
6322 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6323 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6324
6325 - "drop-query"
6326 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6327 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6328 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6329 with a location-type redirect.
6330
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006331 - "append-slash"
6332 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6333 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6334 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6335 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6336
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006337 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6338 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6339 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6340 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6341 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6342 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6343 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6344
6345 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6346 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6347 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6348 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6349 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6350 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6351 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006352
6353 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6354 acl clear dst_port 80
6355 acl secure dst_port 8080
6356 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006357 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006358 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006359 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6360
6361 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006362 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6363 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6364 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006365 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006366
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006367 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6368 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6369 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6370
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006371 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006372 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006373
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006374 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6375 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6376 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006378 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006379
6380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006381redisp (deprecated)
6382redispatch (deprecated)
6383 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6384 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6385 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006386 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006387
6388 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6389 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6390 be able to access the service anymore.
6391
6392 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6393 redistribute them to a working server.
6394
6395 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6396 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6397 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006399 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6400 "option redispatch" instead.
6401
6402 See also : "option redispatch"
6403
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006404
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006405reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006406 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6408 no | yes | yes | yes
6409 Arguments :
6410 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6411 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006412 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006413
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006414 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6415 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6416
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006417 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6418 the last header of an HTTP request.
6419
6420 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6421 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6422 responses.
6423
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006424 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6425 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6426 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6427
6428 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6429 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006430
6431
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006432reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6433reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006434 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6436 no | yes | yes | yes
6437 Arguments :
6438 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6439 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6440 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6441 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6442 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6443 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6444 ignores case.
6445
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006446 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6447 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6448
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006449 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6450 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6451 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6452 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006453 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006454
6455 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6456 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6457
6458 Example :
6459 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6460 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6461 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6462
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006463 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6464 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006465
6466
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006467reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6468reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006469 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6471 no | yes | yes | yes
6472 Arguments :
6473 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6474 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6475 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6476 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6477 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6478 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6479
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006480 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6481 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6482
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006483 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6484 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6485 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6486 next servers.
6487
6488 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6489 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6490 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6491
6492 Example :
6493 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6494 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6495 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6496
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006497 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6498 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006499
6500
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006501reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6502reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006503 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6505 no | yes | yes | yes
6506 Arguments :
6507 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6508 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6509 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6510 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6511 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6512 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6513 case.
6514
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006515 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6516 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6517
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006518 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6519 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6520 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6521 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006522 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006523
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006524 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006525 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006526 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006527
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006528 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6529 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6530
6531 Example :
6532 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6533 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6534 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6535
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006536 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6537 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006538
6539
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006540reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6541reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006542 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6544 no | yes | yes | yes
6545 Arguments :
6546 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6547 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6548 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6549 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6550 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6551 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6552 case.
6553
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006554 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6555 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6556
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006557 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6558 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6559 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6560 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6561
6562 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6563 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6564
6565 Example :
6566 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6567 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6568 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6569 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6570
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006571 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6572 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006573
6574
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006575reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6576reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006577 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6579 no | yes | yes | yes
6580 Arguments :
6581 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6582 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6583 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6584 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6585 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6586 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6587
6588 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6589 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6590 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6591 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006592 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006593
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006594 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6595 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6596
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006597 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6598 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6599 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6600
6601 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6602 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6603 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6604 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6605 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6606
6607 Example :
6608 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006609 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006610 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6611 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6612
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006613 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6614 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006615
6616
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006617reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6618reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006619 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6621 no | yes | yes | yes
6622 Arguments :
6623 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6624 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6625 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6626 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6627 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6628 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6629 ignores case.
6630
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006631 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6632 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6633
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006634 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6635 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006636 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6637 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6638 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006639 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6640 not set.
6641
6642 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6643 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6644 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6645 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6646 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6647
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006648 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006649 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6650 # block all others.
6651 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6652 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6653
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006654 # block bad guys
6655 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6656 reqitarpit . if badguys
6657
6658 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6659 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006660
6661
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006662retries <value>
6663 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6665 yes | no | yes | yes
6666 Arguments :
6667 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6668 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6669 default value is 3.
6670
6671 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6672 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6673 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6674
6675 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006676 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6677 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006678
6679 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6680 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6681
6682 See also : "option redispatch"
6683
6684
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006685rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006686 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6688 no | yes | yes | yes
6689 Arguments :
6690 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6691 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006692 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006693
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006694 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6695 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6696
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006697 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6698 the last header of an HTTP response.
6699
6700 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6701 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6702 responses.
6703
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006704 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6705 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006706
6707
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006708rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6709rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006710 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6712 no | yes | yes | yes
6713 Arguments :
6714 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6715 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6716 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6717 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6718 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6719 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6720 ignores case.
6721
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006722 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6723 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6724
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006725 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6726 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006727 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006728 client.
6729
6730 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6731 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6732 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6733
6734 Example :
6735 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006736 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006737
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006738 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6739 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006740
6741
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006742rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6743rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006744 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6746 no | yes | yes | yes
6747 Arguments :
6748 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6749 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6750 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6751 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6752 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6753 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6754 ignores case.
6755
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006756 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6757 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6758
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006759 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6760 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6761 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6762 case-sensitive.
6763
6764 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006765 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6766 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6767 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006768
6769 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6770 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6771
6772 Example :
6773 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6774 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6775
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006776 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6777 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006778
6779
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006780rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6781rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006782 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6784 no | yes | yes | yes
6785 Arguments :
6786 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6787 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6788 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6789 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6790 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6791 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6792 ignores case.
6793
6794 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6795 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6796 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6797 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006798 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006799
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006800 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6801 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6802
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006803 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6804 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6805 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6806
6807 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6808 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6809 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6810 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6811 are not case-sensitive.
6812
6813 Example :
6814 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6815 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6816
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006817 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6818 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006819
6820
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006821server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006822 Declare a server in a backend
6823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6824 no | no | yes | yes
6825 Arguments :
6826 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006827 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006828 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006829
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006830 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6831 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6832 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6833 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006834 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6835 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6836 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6837 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6838 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006839 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6840 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6841 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6842 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6843 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6844 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6845 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006846 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006847 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6848 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
6849 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006850
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006851 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006852 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6853 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6854 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6855 adding this value to the client's port.
6856
6857 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6858 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006859 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006860
6861 Examples :
6862 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6863 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006864 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006865 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
6866 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
6867 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006868
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006869 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6870 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006871
6872
6873source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006874source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006875source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006876 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6878 yes | no | yes | yes
6879 Arguments :
6880 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6881 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006882
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006883 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006884 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6885 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6886 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6887 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6888 supported prefixes are :
6889 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6890 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6891 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006892 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006893 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
6894 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006895
6896 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6897 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006898 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6899 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6900 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006901
6902 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6903 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6904 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6905 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6906 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6907 <addr>.
6908
6909 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6910 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6911 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6912 port.
6913
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006914 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6915 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6916 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6917 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006918 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006919 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6920 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6921 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6922 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6923 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6924 HTTP header.
6925
6926 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6927 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006928 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006929 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6930 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6931 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6932 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6933 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6934 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6935 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6936
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006937 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6938 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6939 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6940 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6941 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6942 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6943
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006944 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6945 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6946 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6947 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6948
6949 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6950 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6951 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6952 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6953 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6954 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6955
6956 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6957 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6958 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6959 there are two methods :
6960
6961 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6962 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6963 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6964 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6965 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6966 of the client ranges may be used.
6967
6968 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6969 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6970 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6971 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6972 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6973 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6974 same session.
6975
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006976 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6977 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6978 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006979 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006980
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02006981 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
6982
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006983 Examples :
6984 backend private
6985 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6986 source 192.168.1.200
6987
6988 backend transparent_ssl1
6989 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6990 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6991
6992 backend transparent_ssl2
6993 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6994 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6995 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6996
6997 backend transparent_ssl3
6998 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6999 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7000 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7001
7002 backend transparent_smtp
7003 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7004 # with Tproxy version 4.
7005 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7006
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007007 backend transparent_http
7008 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7009 # proxy.
7010 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007012 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007013 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7014
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007015
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007016srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7017 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7019 yes | no | yes | yes
7020 Arguments :
7021 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7022 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7023 as explained at the top of this document.
7024
7025 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7026 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7027 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7028 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7029 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7030 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7031 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7032
7033 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7034 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7035 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7036 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7037 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007038 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007039 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007040 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007041
7042 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7043 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7044 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7045 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7046 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7047 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7048
7049 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7050 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7051
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007052 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7053 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007054
7055
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007056stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7057 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007059 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007060
7061 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7062 matched.
7063
7064 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7065 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7066
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007067 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7068 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7069 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7070
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007071 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7072 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7073 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7074 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007075
7076 Example :
7077 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7078 backend stats_localhost
7079 stats enable
7080 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7081
7082 Example :
7083 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7084 backend stats_auth
7085 stats enable
7086 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7087 stats admin if TRUE
7088
7089 Example :
7090 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7091 userlist stats-auth
7092 group admin users admin
7093 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7094 group readonly users haproxy
7095 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7096
7097 backend stats_auth
7098 stats enable
7099 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7100 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7101 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7102 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7103
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007104 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7105 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7106 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007107
7108
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007109stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7110 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007112 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007113 Arguments :
7114 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7115
7116 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7117
7118 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7119 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7120 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7121 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7122 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7123 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7124
7125 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7126 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7127 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007128 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007129
7130 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7131 report using "stats scope".
7132
7133 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7134 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7135 unobvious parameters.
7136
7137 Example :
7138 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7139 backend public_www
7140 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7141 stats enable
7142 stats hide-version
7143 stats scope .
7144 stats uri /admin?stats
7145 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7146 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7147 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7148
7149 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7150 backend private_monitoring
7151 stats enable
7152 stats uri /admin?stats
7153 stats refresh 5s
7154
7155 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7156
7157
7158stats enable
7159 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007161 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007162 Arguments : none
7163
7164 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7165 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7166 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7167 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7168 - stats auth : no authentication
7169 - stats scope : no restriction
7170
7171 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7172 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7173 unobvious parameters.
7174
7175 Example :
7176 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7177 backend public_www
7178 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7179 stats enable
7180 stats hide-version
7181 stats scope .
7182 stats uri /admin?stats
7183 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7184 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7185 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7186
7187 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7188 backend private_monitoring
7189 stats enable
7190 stats uri /admin?stats
7191 stats refresh 5s
7192
7193 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7194
7195
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007196stats hide-version
7197 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007199 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007200 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007201
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007202 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7203 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7204 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7205 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7206 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7207 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007208
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007209 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7210 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7211 unobvious parameters.
7212
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007213 Example :
7214 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7215 backend public_www
7216 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007217 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007218 stats hide-version
7219 stats scope .
7220 stats uri /admin?stats
7221 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7222 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7223 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007224
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007225 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7226 backend private_monitoring
7227 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007228 stats uri /admin?stats
7229 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007230
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007231 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007232
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007233
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007234stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7235 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7236 Access control for statistics
7237
7238 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7239 no | no | yes | yes
7240
7241 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7242 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7243 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7244 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7245 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7246 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7247
7248 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7249 instance.
7250
7251 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7252 about ACL usage.
7253
7254
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007255stats realm <realm>
7256 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007258 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007259 Arguments :
7260 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7261 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7262 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7263
7264 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7265 using a backslash ('\').
7266
7267 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7268 only related to authentication.
7269
7270 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7271 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7272 unobvious parameters.
7273
7274 Example :
7275 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7276 backend public_www
7277 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7278 stats enable
7279 stats hide-version
7280 stats scope .
7281 stats uri /admin?stats
7282 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7283 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7284 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7285
7286 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7287 backend private_monitoring
7288 stats enable
7289 stats uri /admin?stats
7290 stats refresh 5s
7291
7292 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7293
7294
7295stats refresh <delay>
7296 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007298 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007299 Arguments :
7300 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7301 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7302 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7303 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7304 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7305 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7306
7307 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7308 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7309 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7310 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7311
7312 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7313 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7314 unobvious parameters.
7315
7316 Example :
7317 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7318 backend public_www
7319 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7320 stats enable
7321 stats hide-version
7322 stats scope .
7323 stats uri /admin?stats
7324 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7325 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7326 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7327
7328 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7329 backend private_monitoring
7330 stats enable
7331 stats uri /admin?stats
7332 stats refresh 5s
7333
7334 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7335
7336
7337stats scope { <name> | "." }
7338 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007340 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007341 Arguments :
7342 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7343 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7344 section in which the statement appears.
7345
7346 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7347 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7348 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7349 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7350 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7351 exists.
7352
7353 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7354 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7355 unobvious parameters.
7356
7357 Example :
7358 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7359 backend public_www
7360 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7361 stats enable
7362 stats hide-version
7363 stats scope .
7364 stats uri /admin?stats
7365 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7366 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7367 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7368
7369 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7370 backend private_monitoring
7371 stats enable
7372 stats uri /admin?stats
7373 stats refresh 5s
7374
7375 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7376
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007377
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007378stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007379 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007381 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007382
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007383 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007384 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7385
7386 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7387 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7388
7389 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7390 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007391 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007392
7393 Example :
7394 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7395 backend private_monitoring
7396 stats enable
7397 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7398 stats uri /admin?stats
7399 stats refresh 5s
7400
7401 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7402 global section.
7403
7404
7405stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007406 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7408 yes | yes | yes | yes
7409 Arguments : none
7410
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007411 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007412 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7413 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7414 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7415 - IP (socket, server)
7416 - cookie (backend, server)
7417
7418 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7419 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007420 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007421
7422 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7423
7424
7425stats show-node [ <name> ]
7426 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007428 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007429 Arguments:
7430 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7431 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7432
7433 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7434 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007435 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007436
7437 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7438 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7439 unobvious parameters.
7440
7441 Example:
7442 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7443 backend private_monitoring
7444 stats enable
7445 stats show-node Europe-1
7446 stats uri /admin?stats
7447 stats refresh 5s
7448
7449 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7450 section.
7451
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007452
7453stats uri <prefix>
7454 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007456 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007457 Arguments :
7458 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7459 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7460 query string.
7461
7462 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7463 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7464 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7465 possible to reach it in the application.
7466
7467 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007468 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007469 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7470 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7471 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7472 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7473
7474 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7475 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7476 an address or a port to statistics only.
7477
7478 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7479 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7480 unobvious parameters.
7481
7482 Example :
7483 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7484 backend public_www
7485 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7486 stats enable
7487 stats hide-version
7488 stats scope .
7489 stats uri /admin?stats
7490 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7491 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7492 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7493
7494 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7495 backend private_monitoring
7496 stats enable
7497 stats uri /admin?stats
7498 stats refresh 5s
7499
7500 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7501
7502
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007503stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7504 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007506 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007507
7508 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007509 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007510 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7511 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7512 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7513
7514 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7515 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7516 the "stick-table" statement.
7517
7518 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7519 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7520 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7521 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7522 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7523
7524 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7525 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7526 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7527 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7528 transformation rules.
7529
7530 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7531 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7532 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7533 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7534 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7535 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7536 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7537
7538 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7539 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7540 ACL based conditions.
7541
7542 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7543 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7544 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7545 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7546
7547 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7548 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7549 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7550 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7551
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007552 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7553 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7554 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7555
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007556 Example :
7557 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7558 # last 30 minutes
7559 backend pop
7560 mode tcp
7561 balance roundrobin
7562 stick store-request src
7563 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7564 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7565 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7566
7567 backend smtp
7568 mode tcp
7569 balance roundrobin
7570 stick match src table pop
7571 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7572 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7573
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007574 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007575 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007576
7577
7578stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7579 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7581 no | no | yes | yes
7582
7583 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7584 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7585 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7586 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7587
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007588 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7589 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7590 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7591
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007592 Examples :
7593 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007594 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007595
7596 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7597 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7598 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7599
7600
7601 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7602 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7603 backend http
7604 mode http
7605 balance roundrobin
7606 stick on src table https
7607 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7608 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7609 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7610
7611 backend https
7612 mode tcp
7613 balance roundrobin
7614 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7615 stick on src
7616 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7617 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7618
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007619 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007620
7621
7622stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7623 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7625 no | no | yes | yes
7626
7627 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007628 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007629 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7630 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7631 server is selected.
7632
7633 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7634 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7635 the "stick-table" statement.
7636
7637 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7638 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7639 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7640 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7641 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7642 address.
7643
7644 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7645 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7646 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7647 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7648 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7649 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7650 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7651 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7652 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7653 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7654
7655 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7656 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7657 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7658 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7659 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7660 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7661 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7662
7663 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7664 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7665 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7666 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7667
7668 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7669 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7670 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7671 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7672 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7673 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007674 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7675 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7676 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7677 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7678 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7679 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007680
7681 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7682 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7683 the request.
7684
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007685 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7686 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7687 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7688
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007689 Example :
7690 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7691 # last 30 minutes
7692 backend pop
7693 mode tcp
7694 balance roundrobin
7695 stick store-request src
7696 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7697 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7698 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7699
7700 backend smtp
7701 mode tcp
7702 balance roundrobin
7703 stick match src table pop
7704 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7705 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7706
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007707 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007708 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007709
7710
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007711stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007712 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7713 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007714 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007716 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007717
7718 Arguments :
7719 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7720 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7721 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7722 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7723
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007724 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7725 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7726 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7727 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7728
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007729 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7730 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7731 instance.
7732
7733 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7734 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7735 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7736 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7737 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7738 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007739 to 32 characters.
7740
7741 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7742 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7743 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007744 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007745 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7746 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007747
7748 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007749 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7750 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007751 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7752 increase.
7753
7754 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007755 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7756 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7757 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007758
7759 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7760 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7761 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7762 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7763 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7764 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7765 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7766 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7767 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7768 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7769 parameter (see below).
7770
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007771 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7772 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7773 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7774 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7775 soft restart.
7776
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007777 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7778 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007779
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007780 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7781 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7782 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7783 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7784 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007785 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007786 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7787 if not expiration delay is specified.
7788
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007789 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7790 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7791 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7792 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007793 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7794 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7795 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7796 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7797 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7798 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7799 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7800 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7801 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7802 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7803 types and their arguments.
7804
7805 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7806 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7807 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7808 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7809
7810 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7811 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7812 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7813 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7814
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007815 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7816 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7817 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7818 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7819 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7820 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7821
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007822 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7823 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7824 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7825 they were received.
7826
7827 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7828 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7829 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7830 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7831 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7832
7833 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7834 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7835 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7836 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7837 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7838
7839 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7840 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7841 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7842
7843 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7844 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7845 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7846 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7847 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7848
7849 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7850 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7851 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7852 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7853 the client side.
7854
7855 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7856 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7857 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7858 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7859 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7860 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7861 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7862
7863 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7864 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7865 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7866 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7867 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7868 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7869 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7870
7871 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7872 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7873 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7874 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7875 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7876 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7877
7878 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7879 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7880 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7881 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7882
7883 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7884 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7885 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7886 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7887 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7888 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7889 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7890 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7891 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7892 recommended for better fairness.
7893
7894 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7895 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7896 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7897 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7898
7899 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7900 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7901 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7902 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7903 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7904 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7905 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7906 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7907 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7908 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007909
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007910 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7911 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007912 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7913 reference it.
7914
7915 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7916 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7917 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7918 as an exclusive stickiness.
7919
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007920 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7921 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7922 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7923 something that can be ignored.
7924
7925 Example:
7926 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7927 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7928 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7929 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7930
7931 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007932 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007933
7934
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007935stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7936 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7938 no | no | yes | yes
7939
7940 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007941 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007942 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7943 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7944 server is selected.
7945
7946 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7947 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7948 the "stick-table" statement.
7949
7950 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7951 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7952 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7953 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7954
7955 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7956 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7957 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7958 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7959 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7960 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007961 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007962 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7963 rules.
7964
7965 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7966 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7967 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7968 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7969 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7970 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7971 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7972
7973 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7974 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7975 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7976 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7977
7978 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7979 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7980 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7981 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7982 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7983 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007984 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7985 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7986 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7987 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7988 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7989 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7990 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7991 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7992 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007993
7994 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7995
7996 Example :
7997 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7998 backend https
7999 mode tcp
8000 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008001 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008002 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008003
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008004 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8005 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8006
8007 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8008 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8009 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8010
8011 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8012 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008013
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008014 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8015 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8016 # at offset 44.
8017
8018 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8019 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8020
8021 # Learn on response if server hello.
8022 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008023
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008024 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8025 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8026
8027 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8028 extraction.
8029
8030
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008031tcp-check connect [params*]
8032 Opens a new connection
8033 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8034 no | no | yes | yes
8035
8036 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8037 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8038 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8039
8040 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8041 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8042 of the sequence.
8043
8044 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8045 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8046 do.
8047
8048 Parameters :
8049 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8050 use the TCP connection.
8051
8052 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8053 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8054 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8055
8056 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8057
8058 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8059
8060 Examples:
8061 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8062 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8063 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8064 option tcp-check
8065 tcp-check connect
8066 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8067 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8068 tcp-check send \r\n
8069 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8070 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8071 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8072 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8073 tcp-check send \r\n
8074 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8075 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8076
8077 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8078 option tcp-check
8079 tcp-check connect port 110
8080 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8081 tcp-check connect port 143
8082 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8083 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8084
8085 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8086
8087
8088tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8089 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8090 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8091 no | no | yes | yes
8092
8093 Arguments :
8094 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8095 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8096 binary.
8097 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8098 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8099 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8100
8101 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8102 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8103 with the usual backslash ('\').
8104 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8105 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8106 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8107 used upper or lower case.
8108
8109
8110 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8111
8112 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8113 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8114 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8115 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8116 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8117 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8118 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8119 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8120
8121 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8122 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8123 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8124 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8125 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8126 expression.
8127
8128 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8129 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8130 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8131 this exact hexadecimal string.
8132 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8133
8134 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8135 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8136 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8137 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8138 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8139 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8140 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8141 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8142 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8143 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8144 the null character.
8145
8146 Examples :
8147 # perform a POP check
8148 option tcp-check
8149 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8150
8151 # perform an IMAP check
8152 option tcp-check
8153 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8154
8155 # look for the redis master server
8156 option tcp-check
8157 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008158 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008159 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8160 tcp-check expect string role:master
8161 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8162 tcp-check expect string +OK
8163
8164
8165 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8166 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8167
8168
8169tcp-check send <data>
8170 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8171 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8172 no | no | yes | yes
8173
8174 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8175 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8176
8177 Examples :
8178 # look for the redis master server
8179 option tcp-check
8180 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8181 tcp-check expect string role:master
8182
8183 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8184 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8185
8186
8187tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8188 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8189 tcp health check
8190 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8191 no | no | yes | yes
8192
8193 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8194 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8195 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8196 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8197 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8198 hexadecimal string.
8199 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8200
8201 Examples :
8202 # redis check in binary
8203 option tcp-check
8204 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8205 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8206
8207
8208 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8209 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8210
8211
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008212tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8213 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8215 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008216 Arguments :
8217 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008218 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
8219 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008220
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008221 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008222
8223 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8224 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008225 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8226 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8227 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8228 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8229 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8230 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008231
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008232 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8233 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8234 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8235 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008236
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008237 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008238 - accept :
8239 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8240 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8241 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008242
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008243 - reject :
8244 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8245 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8246 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8247 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8248 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8249 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8250 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8251 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8252 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8253 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8254 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8255 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008256
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008257 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8258 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8259 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8260 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8261 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8262 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8263 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8264 hosts.
8265
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008266 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8267 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8268 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8269 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8270 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8271 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8272 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8273 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8274 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008275 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8276 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008277
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008278 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008279 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008280 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008281 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008282 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8283 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008284 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008285 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8286 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8287 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8288 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8289 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008290
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008291 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008292 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008293 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008294 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8295 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8296 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8297 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008298
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008299 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8300 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8301 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8302 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008304 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8305 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8306 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8307 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8308 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008309 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8310 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8311 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8312 layer7 information is extracted.
8313
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008314 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8315 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8316 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8317 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8318 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008319
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008320 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8321 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8322 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8323 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8324
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008325 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8326 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8327 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8328 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8329 continues.
8330
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008331 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8332 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8333 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008334
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008335 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8336 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8337 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008338
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008339 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008340 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008341 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008342
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008343 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8344 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8345 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008346
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008347 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008348 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8349 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008350
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008351 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8352
8353 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8354
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008355 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8356
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008357 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008358
8359
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008360tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8361 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008363 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008364 Arguments :
8365 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008366 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008367 "track-sc2", "sc-inc-gpc0", "sc-set-gpt0", "capture" and "lua".
8368 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008369
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008370 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008371
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008372 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8373 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8374 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8375 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8376 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008377
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008378 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8379 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8380 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8381 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008382 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8383 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8384 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8385 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8386 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8387 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008388 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008389 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008390
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008391 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8392 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8393 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8394 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008395
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008396 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008397 - accept : the request is accepted
8398 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8399 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008400 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008401 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008402 - set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008403 - lua <function>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008404 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008405
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008406 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8407 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008408
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008409 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8410 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8411 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8412 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8413 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8414 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008415
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008416 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008417 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8418 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008419
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008420 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008421 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8422 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8423 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8424 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008425 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8426 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8427 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008428
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008429 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008430 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8431 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8432 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008433
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008434 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8435 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8436 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8437 documentation.
8438
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008439 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8440 declared inline.
8441
8442 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8443 The allowed scopes are:
8444 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8445 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8446 (request and response)
8447 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8448 processing
8449 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8450 processing.
8451 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8452 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8453
8454 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8455 followed by some converters.
8456
8457 Example:
8458
8459 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8460
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008461 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008462 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8463 # and reject everything else.
8464 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8465 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008466 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008467 tcp-request content reject
8468
8469 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008470 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8471 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8472 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008473 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008474
8475 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8476 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8477 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008478 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008479 tcp-request content reject
8480
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008481 Example:
8482 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8483 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008484 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008485
8486 Example:
8487 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8488 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008489 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008490
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008491 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8492 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8493
8494 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008495 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008496 # protecting all our sites
8497 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008498 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8499 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008500 ...
8501 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8502
8503 backend http_dynamic
8504 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008505 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008506 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008507 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8508 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8509 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008510 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008512 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008513
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008514 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008515
8516
8517tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8518 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008520 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008521 Arguments :
8522 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8523 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8524 as explained at the top of this document.
8525
8526 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8527 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8528 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8529 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8530 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8531
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008532 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8533 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8534 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8535 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8536
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008537 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8538 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008539 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008540 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008541 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8542 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8543 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8544 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008545
8546 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8547 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8548 it pass through unaffected.
8549
8550 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8551 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8552 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008553 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008554 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8555 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008556 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8557 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8558 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008559
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008560 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008561 "timeout client".
8562
8563
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008564tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8565 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8567 no | no | yes | yes
8568 Arguments :
8569 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008570 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua",
8571 "sc-inc-gpc0" and "sc-set-gpt0".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008572
8573 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8574
8575 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8576 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8577 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008578 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8579 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008580
8581 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8582
8583 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8584 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8585 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8586 inserted.
8587
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008588 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008589 - accept :
8590 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8591 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8592 the rules evaluation.
8593
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008594 - close :
8595 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8596 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8597 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8598 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8599 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8600 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008601 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008602 protocols.
8603
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008604 - reject :
8605 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8606 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008607 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008608
Thierry FOURNIER69717b42015-06-04 12:23:41 +02008609 - lua <function>
8610 Executes Lua.
8611
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008612 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
8613 Sets a variable.
8614
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008615 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8616 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8617 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
8618 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
8619
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008620 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
8621 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8622 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8623 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8624 continues.
8625
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008626 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8627 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8628 for changing the default action to a reject.
8629
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008630 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8631 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8632 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8633 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008634 period.
8635
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008636 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8637 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8638 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8639 documentation.
8640
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008641 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8642 declared inline.
8643
8644 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8645 The allowed scopes are:
8646 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8647 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8648 (request and response)
8649 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8650 processing
8651 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8652 processing.
8653 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8654 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8655
8656 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8657 followed by some converters.
8658
8659 Example:
8660
8661 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8662
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008663 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8664
8665 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8666
8667
8668tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8669 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8671 no | no | yes | yes
8672 Arguments :
8673 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8674 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8675 as explained at the top of this document.
8676
8677 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8678
8679
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008680timeout check <timeout>
8681 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8682 established.
8683
8684 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8685 yes | no | yes | yes
8686 Arguments:
8687 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8688 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8689 as explained at the top of this document.
8690
8691 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8692 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8693 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8694 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008695 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8696 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8697 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008698
8699 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8700 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8701
8702 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8703 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008704 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008705
8706 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8707 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8708 forget about it.
8709
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008710 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8711 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008712
8713
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008714timeout client <timeout>
8715timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8716 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8718 yes | yes | yes | no
8719 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008720 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008721 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8722 as explained at the top of this document.
8723
8724 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8725 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8726 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8727 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8728 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8729 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8730 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8731 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008732 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008733 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008734 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8735 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008736 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8737 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008738
8739 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8740 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8741 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8742 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8743 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8744 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8745
8746 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8747 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8748 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8749
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008750 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008751
8752
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008753timeout client-fin <timeout>
8754 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8756 yes | yes | yes | no
8757 Arguments :
8758 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8759 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8760 as explained at the top of this document.
8761
8762 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8763 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8764 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8765 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8766 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8767 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8768 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8769 down in one direction.
8770
8771 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8772 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8773 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8774
8775 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8776
8777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008778timeout connect <timeout>
8779timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8780 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8782 yes | no | yes | yes
8783 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008784 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008785 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8786 as explained at the top of this document.
8787
8788 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008789 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008790 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008791 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008792 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8793 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008794
8795 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8796 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8797 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8798 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8799 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8800 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8801
8802 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8803 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8804 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8805
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008806 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8807 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008808
8809
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008810timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8811 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8813 yes | yes | yes | yes
8814 Arguments :
8815 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8816 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8817 as explained at the top of this document.
8818
8819 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8820 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8821 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8822 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8823 once the request has started to present itself.
8824
8825 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8826 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8827 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8828 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8829 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8830
8831 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8832 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8833 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8834 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8835
8836 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8837 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8838 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8839 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8840 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008841 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008842
8843 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8844 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8845 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8846 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8847
8848 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8849
8850
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008851timeout http-request <timeout>
8852 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008854 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008855 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008856 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008857 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8858 as explained at the top of this document.
8859
8860 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8861 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8862 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8863 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8864 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8865 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8866 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008867 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8868 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8869 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8870 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8871 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008872 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8873 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008874
8875 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8876 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008877 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8878 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008879
8880 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8881 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8882 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8883 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8884 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8885
8886 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008887 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8888 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8889 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008890
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008891 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8892 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008893
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008894
8895timeout queue <timeout>
8896 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8898 yes | no | yes | yes
8899 Arguments :
8900 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8901 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8902 as explained at the top of this document.
8903
8904 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8905 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8906 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8907 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8908 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8909
8910 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8911 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8912 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8913 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8914
8915 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8916
8917
8918timeout server <timeout>
8919timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8920 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8922 yes | no | yes | yes
8923 Arguments :
8924 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8925 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8926 as explained at the top of this document.
8927
8928 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8929 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8930 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8931 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8932 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8933 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8934 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8935
8936 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8937 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8938 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8939 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8940 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008941 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008942 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008943 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8944 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8945 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8946 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008947
8948 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8949 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8950 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8951 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8952 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8953 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8954
8955 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8956 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8957 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8958
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008959 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008960
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008961
8962timeout server-fin <timeout>
8963 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8965 yes | no | yes | yes
8966 Arguments :
8967 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8968 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8969 as explained at the top of this document.
8970
8971 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8972 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8973 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8974 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8975 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8976 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8977 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8978 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8979 situations, it should not be needed.
8980
8981 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8982 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8983 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8984
8985 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8986
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008987
8988timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008989 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8991 yes | yes | yes | yes
8992 Arguments :
8993 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8994 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8995 as explained at the top of this document.
8996
8997 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8998 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8999 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9000
9001 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9002 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9003 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9004 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009005 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009006
9007 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9008
9009
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009010timeout tunnel <timeout>
9011 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9013 yes | no | yes | yes
9014 Arguments :
9015 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9016 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9017 as explained at the top of this document.
9018
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009019 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009020 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9021 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9022 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9023 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9024 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9025 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9026 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9027 specified.
9028
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009029 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9030 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9031 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9032 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9033 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9034 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9035 state.
9036
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009037 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9038 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9039 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9040 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9041 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9042
9043 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9044 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9045 forget about it.
9046
9047 Example :
9048 defaults http
9049 option http-server-close
9050 timeout connect 5s
9051 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009052 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009053 timeout server 30s
9054 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9055
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009056 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009057
9058
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009059transparent (deprecated)
9060 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009062 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009063 Arguments : none
9064
9065 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9066 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9067 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9068 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9069 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9070 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9071 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9072 appropriate server.
9073
9074 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9075
9076 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9077 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9078
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009079 See also: "option transparent"
9080
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009081unique-id-format <string>
9082 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9084 yes | yes | yes | no
9085 Arguments :
9086 <string> is a log-format string.
9087
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009088 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9089 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9090 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9091 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009092
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009093 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9094 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9095 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9096 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9097 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9098 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9099 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9100 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009101
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009102 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9103 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009104
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009105 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009106
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009107 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009108
9109 will generate:
9110
9111 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9112
9113 See also: "unique-id-header"
9114
9115unique-id-header <name>
9116 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9118 yes | yes | yes | no
9119 Arguments :
9120 <name> is the name of the header.
9121
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009122 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9123 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009124
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009125 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009126
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009127 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009128 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9129
9130 will generate:
9131
9132 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9133
9134 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009135
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009136use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009137 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9139 no | yes | yes | no
9140 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009141 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9142 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009143
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009144 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9145 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009146
9147 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9148 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9149 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009150 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9151 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9152 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9153 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009154
9155 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9156 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9157 assign the backend.
9158
9159 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9160 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9161 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9162 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9163 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9164 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9165
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009166 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009167 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009168 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9169 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9170 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9171
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009172 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9173 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9174 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9175 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9176 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9177 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9178 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9179 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9180 cannot be forced from the request.
9181
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009182 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009183 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9184 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9185
9186 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9187 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009188
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009189
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009190use-server <server> if <condition>
9191use-server <server> unless <condition>
9192 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9194 no | no | yes | yes
9195 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009196 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009197
9198 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9199
9200 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9201 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9202 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9203
9204 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9205 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9206 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9207 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9208 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9209 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9210 matches will assign the server.
9211
9212 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9213 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9214 with the next rules until one matches.
9215
9216 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9217 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9218 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9219 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9220
9221 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9222 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9223 stripped.
9224
9225 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9226 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9227 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9228 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9229
9230 Example :
9231 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9232 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9233 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9234 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9235 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9236 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9237 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9238 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9239 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9240
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009241 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009242
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009243
92445. Bind and Server options
9245--------------------------
9246
9247The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9248depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9249settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9250written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9251described in this section.
9252
9253
92545.1. Bind options
9255-----------------
9256
9257The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9258as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9259no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9260parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9261while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9262provided immediately after the setting name.
9263
9264The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9265
9266accept-proxy
9267 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009268 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9269 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009270 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9271 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9272 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9273 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9274 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9275 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9276 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009277 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9278 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009279
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009280alpn <protocols>
9281 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9282 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9283 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9284 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9285 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9286 initial NPN extension.
9287
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009288backlog <backlog>
9289 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9290 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9291
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009292ecdhe <named curve>
9293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009294 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9295 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009296
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009297ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9299 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9300 client's certificate.
9301
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009302ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9303 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9304 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9305 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9306 error is ignored.
9307
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009308ca-sign-file <cafile>
9309 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9310 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9311 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9312 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9313 'generate-certificates' for details.
9314
9315ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9317 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9318 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9319 'generate-certificates' for details.
9320
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009321ciphers <ciphers>
9322 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9323 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009324 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009325 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9326 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9327
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009328crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009329 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9330 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9331 to verify client's certificate.
9332
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009333crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009334 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9335 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9336 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9337 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9338 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9339 file.
9340
9341 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9342 are loaded.
9343
9344 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009345 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009346 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9347 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9348 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9349 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9350 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9351 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9352 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009353
9354 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9355 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9356 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9357 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009358 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9359 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009360
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009361 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009362
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009363 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9364 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009365 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009366 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9367 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9368 clients).
9369
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009370 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9371 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9372 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9373 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9374 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9375 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9376 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9377 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9378 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9379 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9380 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9381 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9382 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9383
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009384 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9385 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9386 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9387 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9388 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9389
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009390crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009391 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9392 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009393 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009394 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009395
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009396crt-list <file>
9397 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009398 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9399 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009400
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009401 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009402
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009403 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9404 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9405 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9406 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9407 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9408 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9409 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9410 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009411
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009412defer-accept
9413 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9414 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9415 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9416 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9417 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9418 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9419 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9420 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9421 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9422 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9423 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9424
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009425force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009426 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009427 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009428 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9429 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009430
9431force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009432 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009433 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9434 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009435
9436force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009437 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009438 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9439 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009440
9441force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009442 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009443 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9444 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009445
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009446generate-certificates
9447 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9448 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9449 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9450 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9451 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9452 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9453 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9454 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9455 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9456 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9457 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9458
9459 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9460 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9461 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9462 certificate is used many times.
9463
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009464gid <gid>
9465 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9466 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9467 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9468 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9469 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9470
9471group <group>
9472 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9473 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9474 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9475 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9476 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9477
9478id <id>
9479 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9480 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9481 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9482 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9483
9484interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009485 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9486 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9487 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9488 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9489 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9490 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9491 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009492
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009493level <level>
9494 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9495 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9496 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9497 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9498 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9499 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9500 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9501 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9502 counters).
9503 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9504 all counters).
9505
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009506maxconn <maxconn>
9507 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9508 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9509 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9510 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9511 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9512 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9513 eat all memory.
9514
9515mode <mode>
9516 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9517 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9518 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9519 UNIX sockets.
9520
9521mss <maxseg>
9522 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9523 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9524 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9525 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9526 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9527 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9528 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9529 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9530 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9531 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9532 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9533
9534name <name>
9535 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9536 page.
9537
9538nice <nice>
9539 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9540 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9541 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9542 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9543 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9544 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9545 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9546 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9547 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9548 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9549 one for an RDP socket.
9550
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009551no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009552 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009553 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009554 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009555 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9556 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009557 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009558
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009559no-tls-tickets
9560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9561 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9562 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009563 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9564 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009565
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009566no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009567 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009568 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009569 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009570 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9571 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9572 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009573
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009574no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009575 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009576 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009577 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009578 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9579 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9580 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009581
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009582no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009583 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009584 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009585 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009586 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9587 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9588 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009589
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009590npn <protocols>
9591 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9592 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9593 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9594 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009595 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9596 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009597
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009598process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9599 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9600 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9601 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9602 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9603 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9604 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9605 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009606 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9607 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9608 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9609 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9610 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9611 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9612 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009613
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009614ssl
9615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009616 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009617 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9618 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9619 to deciphered contents.
9620
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009621strict-sni
9622 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9623 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9624 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9625 See the "crt" option for more information.
9626
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009627tcp-ut <delay>
9628 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9629 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9630 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9631 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9632 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9633 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9634 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9635 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9636 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9637 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9638 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9639
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009640tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009641 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009642 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9643 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9644 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9645 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9646 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9647 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9648 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009649 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9650 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9651 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009652
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009653tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9654 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9655 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9656 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9657 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9658 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9659 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9660 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9661 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9662 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9663 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9664
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009665transparent
9666 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9667 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9668 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9669 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9670 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9671 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9672 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9673 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9674 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9675 so check for support with your vendor.
9676
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009677v4v6
9678 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9679 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9680 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9681 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009682 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009683
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009684v6only
9685 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9686 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9687 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009688 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9689 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009690
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009691uid <uid>
9692 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9693 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9694 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9695 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9696 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9697
9698user <user>
9699 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9700 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9701 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9702 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9703 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9704
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009705verify [none|optional|required]
9706 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9707 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9708 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9709 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9710 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009711 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9712 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9713 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9714 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009715
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020097165.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009717------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009719The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9720which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9721arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9722settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9723after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9724Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9725address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009726
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009727 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009728 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009730The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009731
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009732addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009733 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9734 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9735 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9736 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9737 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009738
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009739 Supported in default-server: No
9740
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009741agent-check
9742 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009743 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9744 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9745 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9746 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009747
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009748 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009749 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009750 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9751 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9752 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009753
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009754 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9755 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009756
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009757 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9758 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9759 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009760
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009761 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9762 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9763 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009764
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009765 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9766 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9767 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9768 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9769 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9770 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9771 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009772
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009773 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9774 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009775
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009776 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9777 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9778 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9779 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9780 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9781 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9782 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9783 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9784 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009785
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009786 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9787 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009788 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9789 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9790 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9791 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009792
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009793 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9794 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009795
9796 Supported in default-server: No
9797
9798agent-inter <delay>
9799 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9800 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9801
9802 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9803 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9804 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9805 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9806 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9807 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9808 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9809 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9810 of backends use the same servers.
9811
9812 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9813
9814 Supported in default-server: Yes
9815
9816agent-port <port>
9817 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9818
9819 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9820
9821 Supported in default-server: Yes
9822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009823backup
9824 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9825 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9826 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9827 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9828 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9829 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009830
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009831 Supported in default-server: No
9832
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009833ca-file <cafile>
9834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9835 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9836 server's certificate.
9837
9838 Supported in default-server: No
9839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009840check
9841 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009842 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9843 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9844 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9845 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9846 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9847 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9848 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009849 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9850 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9851 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009853 Supported in default-server: No
9854
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009855check-send-proxy
9856 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9857 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9858 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9859 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9860 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9861 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9862 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9863
9864 Supported in default-server: No
9865
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009866check-ssl
9867 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9868 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9869 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9870 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009871 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009872 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9873 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9874 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9875 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9876
9877 Supported in default-server: No
9878
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009879ciphers <ciphers>
9880 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009881 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009882 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9883 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9884 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9885 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9886 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9887 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9888
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009889 Supported in default-server: No
9890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009891cookie <value>
9892 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9893 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9894 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9895 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9896 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9897 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9898 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009900 Supported in default-server: No
9901
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009902crl-file <crlfile>
9903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9904 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9905 to verify server's certificate.
9906
9907 Supported in default-server: No
9908
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009909crt <cert>
9910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9911 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9912 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9913 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9914 certificate request.
9915
9916 Supported in default-server: No
9917
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009918disabled
9919 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9920 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9921 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9922 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9923 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9924
9925 Supported in default-server: No
9926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009927error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009928 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9929 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9930 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009931
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009932 Supported in default-server: Yes
9933
9934 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009936fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009937 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9938 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9939 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009941 Supported in default-server: Yes
9942
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009943force-sslv3
9944 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9945 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009946 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9947 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009948
9949 Supported in default-server: No
9950
9951force-tlsv10
9952 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009953 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9954 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009955
9956 Supported in default-server: No
9957
9958force-tlsv11
9959 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009960 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9961 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009962
9963 Supported in default-server: No
9964
9965force-tlsv12
9966 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009967 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9968 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009969
9970 Supported in default-server: No
9971
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009972id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009973 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9974 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9975 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009977 Supported in default-server: No
9978
9979inter <delay>
9980fastinter <delay>
9981downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009982 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9983 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9984 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9985 between checks depending on the server state :
9986
9987 Server state | Interval used
9988 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9989 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9990 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9991 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9992 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9993 or yet unchecked. |
9994 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9995 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9996 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009998 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9999 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10000 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10001 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010002 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10003 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10004 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10005 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10006 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010007
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010008 Supported in default-server: Yes
10009
10010maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010011 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10012 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10013 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10014 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10015 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10016 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10017 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10018 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010020 Supported in default-server: Yes
10021
10022maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010023 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10024 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10025 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10026 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10027 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10028 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10029 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10030
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010031 Supported in default-server: Yes
10032
10033minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010034 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10035 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10036 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10037 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10038 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10039 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010040 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010041 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010043 Supported in default-server: Yes
10044
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010045no-ssl-reuse
10046 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10047 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10048 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10049 and for paranoid users.
10050
10051 Supported in default-server: No
10052
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010053no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010054 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10055 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010056 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010057
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010058 Supported in default-server: No
10059
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010060no-tls-tickets
10061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10062 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10063 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010064 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10065 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010066
10067 Supported in default-server: No
10068
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010069no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010070 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010071 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10072 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010073 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10074 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10075 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010076
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010077 Supported in default-server: No
10078
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010079no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010080 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010081 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10082 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010083 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10084 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10085 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010086
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010087 Supported in default-server: No
10088
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010089no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010090 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010091 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10092 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010093 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10094 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10095 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010096
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010097 Supported in default-server: No
10098
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010099non-stick
10100 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10101 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10102 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10103
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010104 Supported in default-server: No
10105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010106observe <mode>
10107 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10108 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10109 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10110 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10111 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10112 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010113 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010115 Supported in default-server: No
10116
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010117 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010119on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010120 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10121 Currently, four modes are available:
10122 - fastinter: force fastinter
10123 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10124 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10125 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10126 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010128 Supported in default-server: Yes
10129
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010130 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10131
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010132on-marked-down <action>
10133 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10134 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010135 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10136 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10137 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10138 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10139 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10140 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10141 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10142 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010143
10144 Actions are disabled by default
10145
10146 Supported in default-server: Yes
10147
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010148on-marked-up <action>
10149 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10150 Currently one action is available:
10151 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10152 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10153 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10154 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10155 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10156 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10157 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10158 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10159
10160 Actions are disabled by default
10161
10162 Supported in default-server: Yes
10163
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010164port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010165 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10166 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10167 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10168 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10169 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10170 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010172 Supported in default-server: Yes
10173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010174redir <prefix>
10175 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10176 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10177 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10178 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10179 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10180 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10181 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10182 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010183 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010184 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10185 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10186 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10187 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10188 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10189
10190 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10191
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010192 Supported in default-server: No
10193
10194rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010195 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10196 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10197 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010199 Supported in default-server: Yes
10200
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010201resolve-prefer <family>
10202 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10203 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10204 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10205 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10206
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010207 Default value: ipv6
10208
10209 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010210
10211 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10212
10213resolvers <id>
10214 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10215 hostname.
10216
10217 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns
10218
10219 See also chapter 5.3
10220
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010221send-proxy
10222 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10223 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10224 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10225 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
10226 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
10227 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
10228 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
10229 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
10230 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010231 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
10232 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
10233 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
10234 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
10235 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010236
10237 Supported in default-server: No
10238
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010239send-proxy-v2
10240 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10241 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10242 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10243 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10244 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10245 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10246 option of the "bind" keyword.
10247
10248 Supported in default-server: No
10249
10250send-proxy-v2-ssl
10251 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10252 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10253 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10254 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10255 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10256 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10257 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10258 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10259
10260 Supported in default-server: No
10261
10262send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10263 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10264 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10265 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10266 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10267 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10268 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10269 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10270 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10271 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10272
10273 Supported in default-server: No
10274
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010275slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010276 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10277 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10278 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10279 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10280 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10281 parameters :
10282
10283 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10284 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10285
10286 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10287 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10288 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10289 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10290
10291 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10292 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10293 seen as failed.
10294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010295 Supported in default-server: Yes
10296
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010297sni <expression>
10298 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10299 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10300 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10301 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10302 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10303
10304 Supported in default-server: no
10305
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010306source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010307source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010308source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010309 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10310 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10311 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10312 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10313
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010314 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10315 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10316 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10317 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10318 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10319 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10320 server.
10321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010322 Supported in default-server: No
10323
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010324ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010325 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10326 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10327 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10328 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10329 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10330 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010331 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010332
10333 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010335track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010336 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10337 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10338 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10339 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010340 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010342 Supported in default-server: No
10343
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010344verify [none|required]
10345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010346 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10347 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10348 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10349 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010350 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10351 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10352 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010353
10354 Supported in default-server: No
10355
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010356verifyhost <hostname>
10357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10358 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10359 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10360 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10361 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10362 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10363
10364 Supported in default-server: No
10365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010366weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010367 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10368 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10369 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010370 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10371 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10372 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10373 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10374 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10375 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010377 Supported in default-server: Yes
10378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010379
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200103805.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
10381-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010382
10383HAProxy allows using a host name to be resolved to find out what is the server
10384IP address. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10385configuration, at startup.
10386This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10387can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10388workload.
10389This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10390resolution at run time.
10391Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10392carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10393
10394
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200103955.3.1. Global overview
10396----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010397
10398As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10399different steps of the process life:
10400
10401 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10402 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10403 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10404
10405 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10406 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10407 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10408
10409A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10410 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10411 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10412 resolution to know this new IP.
10413
10414A few things important to notice:
10415 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10416 first valid response.
10417
10418 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10419 servers return an error.
10420
10421
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200104225.3.2. The resolvers section
10423----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010424
10425This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10426HAProxy.
10427There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10428many name servers.
10429
10430resolvers <resolvers id>
10431 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
10432
10433A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
10434
10435nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
10436 DNS server description:
10437 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
10438 <ip> : IP address of the server
10439 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
10440
10441hold <status> <period>
10442 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
10443 on last resolution <status>
10444 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
10445 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
10446 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10447 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
10448
10449 Default value is 10s for "valid".
10450
10451 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
10452 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
10453 the healch check.
10454
10455resolve_retries <nb>
10456 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
10457 giving up.
10458 Default value: 3
10459
10460timeout <event> <time>
10461 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
10462 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
10463 events available are:
10464 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
10465 been received.
10466 Default value: 1s
10467 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10468 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
10469
10470Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
10471
10472 resolvers mydns
10473 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
10474 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
10475 resolve_retries 3
10476 timeout retry 1s
10477 hold valid 10s
10478
10479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200104806. HTTP header manipulation
10481---------------------------
10482
10483In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10484response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10485request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10486which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010487against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010488
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010489If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10490to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10491but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10492HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10493stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10494because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10495a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10496still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010498This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10499in section 4.2 :
10500
10501 - reqadd <string>
10502 - reqallow <search>
10503 - reqiallow <search>
10504 - reqdel <search>
10505 - reqidel <search>
10506 - reqdeny <search>
10507 - reqideny <search>
10508 - reqpass <search>
10509 - reqipass <search>
10510 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10511 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10512 - reqtarpit <search>
10513 - reqitarpit <search>
10514 - rspadd <string>
10515 - rspdel <search>
10516 - rspidel <search>
10517 - rspdeny <search>
10518 - rspideny <search>
10519 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10520 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10521
10522With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10523is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
10524parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
10525prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
10526Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
10527
10528 \t for a tab
10529 \r for a carriage return (CR)
10530 \n for a new line (LF)
10531 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
10532 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10533 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10534 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10535 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10536
10537The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10538portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10539above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10540regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
105419 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10542is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10543
10544The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10545after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10546
10547Notes related to these keywords :
10548---------------------------------
10549 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10550 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10551 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10552
10553 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10554 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10555 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10556
10557 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10558 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10559 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10560 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10561 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10562
10563 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10564 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10565 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10566 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10567 useless headers before adding new ones.
10568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010569 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010570 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10571
10572 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10573 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10574 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10575
10576 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10577 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010578 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010579
10580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200105817. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10582----------------------------------
10583
10584Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10585client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10586The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10587these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10588but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10589data called patterns.
10590
10591
105927.1. ACL basics
10593---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010594
10595The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10596content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10597from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10598simple :
10599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010600 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010601 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010602 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10603 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010605The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10606adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010607
10608In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010610 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010611
10612This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10613Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10614and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010615an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10616conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10617as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10618are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010619
10620ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10621'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10622which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10623
10624There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10625performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010627The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10628specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10629this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010630methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10631ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010632
10633Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10634 - boolean
10635 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10636 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10637 - string
10638 - data block
10639
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010640Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10641converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10642would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10643The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10644which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10645
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010646Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10647keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10648fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10649which are summarized in the table below :
10650
10651 +---------------------+-----------------+
10652 | Sample or converter | Default |
10653 | output type | matching method |
10654 +---------------------+-----------------+
10655 | boolean | bool |
10656 +---------------------+-----------------+
10657 | integer | int |
10658 +---------------------+-----------------+
10659 | ip | ip |
10660 +---------------------+-----------------+
10661 | string | str |
10662 +---------------------+-----------------+
10663 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10664 +---------------------+-----------------+
10665
10666Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10667matching method, see below.
10668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010669The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10670 - boolean
10671 - integer or integer range
10672 - IP address / network
10673 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10674 - regular expression
10675 - hex block
10676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010677The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10678
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010679 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10680 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010681 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010682 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010683 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010684 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010685 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010687The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10688read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10689if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10690lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10691will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10692beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10693a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10694lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10695exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10696
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010697The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10698parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10699ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10700a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10701check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10702
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010703The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10704socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10705file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010707Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10708loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10709
10710 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10711
10712In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10713the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10714case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10715as well.
10716
10717The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10718sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10719do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10720methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10721is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10722obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10723followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10724default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10725that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10726string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10727
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010728The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10729By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10730string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10731resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10732server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10733waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10734flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10735function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010737There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10738sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10739be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010740
10741 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10742 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010743 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10744 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10745 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10746 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010747
10748 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10749 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010750 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010751
10752 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010753 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010754
10755 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010756 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010757
10758 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10759 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10760
10761 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10762 binary or string samples.
10763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010764 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10765 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010767 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10768 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10769 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010771 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10772 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010774 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10775 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010777 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10778 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010780 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10781 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010782 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010784 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10785 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10786 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010787
10788For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10789request, it is possible to do :
10790
10791 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10792
10793In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10794buffer, one would use the following acl :
10795
10796 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10797
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010798On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10799possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10800
10801 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010803All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10804criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10805method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10806to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10807criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10808the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010810If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010811the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10812For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010814 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10815 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10816 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10817 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010818
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010819
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010820The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10821types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10822combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10823brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10824default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010826 +-------------------------------------------------+
10827 | Input sample type |
10828 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010829 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010830 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10831 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10832 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010833 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010834 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010835 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010836 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010837 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010838 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010839 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010840 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010841 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010842 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010843 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010844 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010845 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010846 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010847 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010848 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010849 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010850 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010851 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010852 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010853 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010854 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10855 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10856 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010857
10858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108597.1.1. Matching booleans
10860------------------------
10861
10862In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10863Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10864When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10865that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10866
10867Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10868return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10869"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10870
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200108727.1.2. Matching integers
10873------------------------
10874
10875Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10876enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10877to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10878
10879Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10880matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10881lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010882
10883For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10884unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10885representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10886
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010887As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10888two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10889instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10890ranges and operators.
10891
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010892For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010893operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10894Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10895of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010896
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010897Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010898
10899 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10900 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10901 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10902 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10903 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10904
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010905For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010906
10907 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10908
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010909This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10910
10911 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10912
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200109147.1.3. Matching strings
10915-----------------------
10916
10917String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10918different forms :
10919
10920 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10921 patterns ;
10922
10923 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10924 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10925
10926 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10927 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10928
10929 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10930 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10931
10932 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10933 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10934 matches.
10935
10936 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10937 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10938 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010939
10940String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10941exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10942characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10943string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10944to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010945before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010946
10947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200109487.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10949---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010950
10951Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10952they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10953possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10954passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10955the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010956the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10957match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010958
10959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200109607.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10961-------------------------------------
10962
10963It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10964not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10965a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10966to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10967digits may be used upper or lower case.
10968
10969Example :
10970 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10971 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10972
10973
109747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10975---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010976
10977IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10978netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10979within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010980host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010981difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10982at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10983does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10984parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010985
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010986IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10987Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10988trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10989IPv6 patterns.
10990
10991HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10992following situations :
10993 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10994 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10995 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10996 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10997 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10998 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10999 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11000 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11001 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11002 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011004
110057.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11006----------------------------------
11007
11008Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11009combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11010
11011 - AND (implicit)
11012 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11013 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011015A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011017 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011019Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11020indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011022For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11023"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11024requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11025is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11026
11027 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11028 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11029 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11030 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11031
11032To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11033and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11034
11035 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11036 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11037 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11038 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11039
11040 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11041 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11042 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11043 use_backend www if host_www
11044
11045It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11046expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11047be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11048the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11049
11050 The following rule :
11051
11052 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11053 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11054
11055 Can also be written that way :
11056
11057 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11058
11059It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11060to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11061simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11062sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11063good use is the following :
11064
11065 With named ACLs :
11066
11067 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11068 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11069 monitor fail if site_dead
11070
11071 With anonymous ACLs :
11072
11073 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11074
11075See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11076
11077
110787.3. Fetching samples
11079---------------------
11080
11081Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11082against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11083sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11084ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11085of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11086available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11087
11088This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11089Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11090compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11091deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11092
11093The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11094matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11095method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11096indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11097
11098As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11099when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11100mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11101the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11102ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11103
11104Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11105multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11106when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11107incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11108are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11109is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11110all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11111
11112Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11113 - name
11114 - name(arg1)
11115 - name(arg1,arg2)
11116
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011117
111187.3.1. Converters
11119-----------------
11120
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011121Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11122of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11123is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11124was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11125has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11126unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11127
11128These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11129sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11130the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11131support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011132
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011133A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11134support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11135supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11136(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11137bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011139The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011140
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011141add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011142 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011143 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
11144 name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope. The
11145 allowed scopes are:
11146 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11147 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11148 response),
11149 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11150 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11151 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11152 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011153
11154and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011155 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011156 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11157 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11158 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11159 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11160 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11161 response),
11162 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11163 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11164 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11165 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011166
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011167base64
11168 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11169 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11170 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11171
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011172bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011173 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011174 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11175 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11176 presence of a flag).
11177
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011178bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11179 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11180 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11181 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11182
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011183cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011184 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11185 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011186
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011187crc32([<avalanche>])
11188 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11189 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11190 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11191 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11192 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11193 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11194 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11195 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11196 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11197 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11198 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11199
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011200da-csv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
11201 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11202 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11203 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11204 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
11205 ('|'). There's a limit of 5 different properties imposed by the haproxy
11206 configuration language.
11207
11208 Example:
11209 frontend www
11210 bind *:8881
11211 default_backend servers
11212 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion)]
11213
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011214debug
11215 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11216 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11217 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11218
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011219div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011220 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11221 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011222 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
11223 variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about it
11224 scope. The scope allowed are:
11225 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11226 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11227 response),
11228 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11229 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11230 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11231 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011232
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011233djb2([<avalanche>])
11234 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11235 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11236 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11237 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11238 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11239 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11240 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011241 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11242 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011243
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011244even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011245 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011246 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11247
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011248field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11249 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11250 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11251 list of chars.
11252
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011253hex
11254 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11255 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11256 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11257 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011258
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011259http_date([<offset>])
11260 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11261 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11262 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11263 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11264 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11265 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011266
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011267in_table(<table>)
11268 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11269 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11270 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11271 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11272 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11273
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011274ipmask(<mask>)
11275 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11276 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11277 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11278 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11279
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011280json([<input-code>])
11281 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11282 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11283 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11284 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11285 of errors:
11286 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11287 bytes, ...)
11288 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11289 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11290
11291 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11292 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11293 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11294 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11295 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11296 are :
11297 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11298 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11299 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11300 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11301 error ;
11302 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11303 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11304
11305 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11306 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11307
11308 Example:
11309 capture request header user-agent len 150
11310 capture request header Host len 15
11311 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
11312
11313 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11314 GET / HTTP/1.0
11315 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11316
11317 Output log:
11318 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11319
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011320language(<value>[,<default>])
11321 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11322 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11323 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11324 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11325 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11326 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11327 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11328 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11329 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11330 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11331 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11332 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011333
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011334 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011335
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011336 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11337 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011338
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011339 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11340 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11341 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11342 use_backend spanish if es
11343 use_backend french if fr
11344 use_backend english if en
11345 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011346
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011347lower
11348 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11349 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11350 type. The result is of type string.
11351
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011352ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11353 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11354 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11355 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11356 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11357 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11358 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11359
11360 Example :
11361
11362 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11363 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11364 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11365
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011366map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11367map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11368map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11369 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11370 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11371 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11372 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11373 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11374 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11375 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11376 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011377
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011378 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11379 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11380 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011381
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011382 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11383 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011384
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011385 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11386 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11387 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11388 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011389 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11390 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011391 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11392 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11393 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11394 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11395 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11396 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11397 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11398 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11399 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11400 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11401 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11402 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11403 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11404 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011405
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011406 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
11407 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
11408 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
11409 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
11410 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011411
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011412 Example :
11413
11414 # this is a comment and is ignored
11415 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
11416 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
11417 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
11418 | | | `---------- value
11419 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11420 | `---------------------------- key
11421 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11422
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011423mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011424 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11425 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011426 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11427 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11428 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11429 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11430 response),
11431 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11432 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11433 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11434 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011435
11436mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011437 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020011438 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
11439 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011440 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11441 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11442 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11443 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11444 response),
11445 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11446 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11447 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11448 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011449
11450neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011451 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
11452 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
11453 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
11454 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011455
11456not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011457 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011458 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11459 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11460 absence of a flag).
11461
11462odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011463 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011464 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
11465
11466or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011467 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011468 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11469 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11470 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11471 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11472 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11473 response),
11474 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11475 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11476 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11477 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011478
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010011479regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011480 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
11481 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
11482 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
11483 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
11484 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
11485 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
11486 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
11487 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
11488 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
11489 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
11490 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
11491 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
11492 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
11493
11494 Example :
11495
11496 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
11497 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
11498 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
11499 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
11500
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011501capture-req(<id>)
11502 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
11503 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11504
11505 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11506 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11507 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11508
11509capture-res(<id>)
11510 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
11511 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11512
11513 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11514 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11515 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11516
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011517sdbm([<avalanche>])
11518 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
11519 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11520 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11521 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11522 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11523 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11524 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011525 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
11526 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011527
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011528set-var(<var name>)
11529 Sets a variable with the input content and return the content on the output as
11530 is. The variable keep the value and the associated input type. The name of the
11531 variable starts by an indication about it scope. The scope allowed are:
11532 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11533 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11534 response),
11535 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11536 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11537 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11538 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11539
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011540sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011541 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
11542 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011543 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
11544 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
11545 scope. The allowed scopes are:
11546 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11547 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11548 response),
11549 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11550 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11551 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11552 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011553
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011554table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
11555 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11556 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11557 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
11558 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11559 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11560 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
11561
11562
11563table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
11564 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11565 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11566 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
11567 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11568 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11569 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
11570
11571table_conn_cnt(<table>)
11572 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11573 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11574 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11575 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
11576 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11577
11578table_conn_cur(<table>)
11579 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11580 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11581 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11582 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11583 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
11584
11585table_conn_rate(<table>)
11586 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11587 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11588 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
11589 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11590 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
11591
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011592table_gpt0(<table>)
11593 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11594 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
11595 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11596 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11597 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
11598
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011599table_gpc0(<table>)
11600 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11601 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11602 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11603 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
11604 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
11605
11606table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
11607 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11608 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11609 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
11610 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
11611 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
11612 sample fetch keyword.
11613
11614table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
11615 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11616 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11617 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11618 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11619 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11620
11621table_http_err_rate(<table>)
11622 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11623 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11624 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
11625 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
11626 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
11627 keyword.
11628
11629table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
11630 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11631 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11632 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11633 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
11634 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11635
11636table_http_req_rate(<table>)
11637 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11638 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11639 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
11640 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
11641 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
11642 keyword.
11643
11644table_kbytes_in(<table>)
11645 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11646 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11647 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
11648 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11649 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11650 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11651 keyword.
11652
11653table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11654 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11655 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11656 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11657 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11658 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11659 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
11660 keyword.
11661
11662table_server_id(<table>)
11663 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11664 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11665 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
11666 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
11667 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
11668 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
11669
11670table_sess_cnt(<table>)
11671 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11672 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11673 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11674 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
11675 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11676 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
11677 keyword.
11678
11679table_sess_rate(<table>)
11680 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11681 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11682 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
11683 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
11684 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
11685 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
11686 keyword.
11687
11688table_trackers(<table>)
11689 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11690 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11691 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11692 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
11693 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
11694 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
11695 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
11696 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
11697 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
11698 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
11699
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011700upper
11701 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
11702 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11703 type. The result is of type string.
11704
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020011705url_dec
11706 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
11707 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
11708
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011709utime(<format>[,<offset>])
11710 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11711 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
11712 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11713 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11714 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11715 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
11716
11717 Example :
11718
11719 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
11720 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11721 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11722
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010011723word(<index>,<delimiters>)
11724 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
11725 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
11726
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011727wt6([<avalanche>])
11728 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
11729 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11730 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11731 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11732 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11733 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11734 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011735 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
11736 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011737
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011738xor(<value>)
11739 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011740 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011741 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11742 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11743 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11744 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11745 response),
11746 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11747 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11748 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11749 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011750
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011751
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200117527.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011753--------------------------------------------
11754
11755A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
11756not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
11757"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
11758The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
11759
11760always_false : boolean
11761 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11762 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11763
11764always_true : boolean
11765 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11766 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11767
11768avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011769 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011770 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
11771 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
11772 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
11773 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
11774 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
11775 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
11776 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
11777 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11778 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11779 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11780 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11781 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11782 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011784be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011785 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11786 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11787 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11788 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11789 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011791be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11792 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11793 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11794 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11795 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11796 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11797 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011798
11799 Example :
11800 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11801 backend dynamic
11802 mode http
11803 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11804 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011805
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011806bin(<hexa>) : bin
11807 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
11808 of the string.
11809
11810bool(<bool>) : bool
11811 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
11812 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
11813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011814connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11815 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011816 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011817 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11818 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011819
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011820 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011821 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011822 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11823
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011824 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11825 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011826
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011827 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011828 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011829 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011830 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11831 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011832 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011833 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011834
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011835 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11836 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011837 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011838 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011839
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011840date([<offset>]) : integer
11841 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11842 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11843 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11844 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011845 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11846
11847 Example :
11848
11849 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11850 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011851
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011852env(<name>) : string
11853 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11854 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11855 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11856 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11857 certain way.
11858
11859 Examples :
11860 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11861 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11862
11863 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11864 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011866fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11867 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011868 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11869 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011870 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11871 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11872 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11873 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11874 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011876fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11877 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11878 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11879 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11880 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11881 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11882 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11883 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11884 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011885
11886 Example :
11887 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11888 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11889 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11890 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11891 frontend mail
11892 bind :25
11893 mode tcp
11894 maxconn 100
11895 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11896 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11897 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11898 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011899
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011900int(<integer>) : signed integer
11901 Returns a signed integer.
11902
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011903ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
11904 Returns an ipv4.
11905
11906ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
11907 Returns an ipv6.
11908
11909meth(<method>) : method
11910 Returns a method.
11911
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011912nbproc : integer
11913 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11914 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11915 and debugging purposes.
11916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011917nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11918 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11919 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11920 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011921 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11922 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11923 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011924
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011925proc : integer
11926 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11927 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11928 debugging purposes.
11929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011930queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011931 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11932 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11933 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011934 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11935 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11936 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11937 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11938 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11939
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011940rand([<range>]) : integer
11941 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11942 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11943 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11944 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11945 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011947srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11948 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11949 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11950 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11951 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11952 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11953 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11954 methods.
11955
11956srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11957 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11958 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11959 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11960 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11961 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11962 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11963 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11964
11965srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11966 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11967 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011968 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011969 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11970 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11971 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11972 overloading servers).
11973
11974 Example :
11975 # Redirect to a separate back
11976 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11977 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11978 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11979
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011980stopping : boolean
11981 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11982 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11983 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11984
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020011985str(<string>) : string
11986 Returns a string.
11987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011988table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11989 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11990 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11991
11992table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11993 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11994 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11995 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11996
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011997var(<var-name>) : undefined
11998 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
11999 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
12000 scope. The scope allowed are:
12001 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
12002 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
12003 response),
12004 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
12005 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
12006 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12007 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012009
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200120107.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012011----------------------------------
12012
12013The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12014closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12015methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12016sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12017TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012018the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12019counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12020"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012021argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12022the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12023this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012024
12025be_id : integer
12026 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12027 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12028
12029dst : ip
12030 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12031 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12032 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12033 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12034 RFC 4291.
12035
12036dst_conn : integer
12037 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12038 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12039 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12040 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12041 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12042 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12043 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12044 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012046dst_port : integer
12047 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12048 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12049 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12050 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12051 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12052 an HTTP header.
12053
12054fe_id : integer
12055 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12056 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12057 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12058
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012059sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012060sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12061sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12062sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012063 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12064 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12065 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12066
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012067sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012068sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12069sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12070sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012071 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12072 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12073 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12074
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012075sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012076sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12077sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12078sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012079 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12080 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012081 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12082 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12083 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012084
12085 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12086 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012087 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12088 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12089 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012090 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12091 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12092
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012093sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012094sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12095sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12096sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012097 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12098 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12099
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012100sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012101sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12102sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12103sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012104 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12105 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12106 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12107
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012108sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012109sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12110sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12111sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012112 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12113 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12114 See also src_conn_rate.
12115
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012116sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012117sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12118sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12119sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012120 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012121 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012122
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012123sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12124sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12125sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12126sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12127 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12128 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12129
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012130sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012131sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12132sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12133sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012134 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12135 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12136 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012137 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12138 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12139 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012140
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012141sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012142sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12143sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12144sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012145 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12146 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12147 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12148
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012149sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012150sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12151sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12152sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012153 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12154 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12155 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12156 src_http_err_rate.
12157
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012158sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012159sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12160sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12161sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012162 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12163 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12164 src_http_req_cnt.
12165
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012166sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012167sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12168sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12169sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012170 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12171 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12172 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12173 src_http_req_rate.
12174
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012175sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012176sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12177sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12178sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012179 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012180 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12181 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12182 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12183 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012184
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012185 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12186 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012187 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12188
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012189sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012190sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12191sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12192sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012193 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12194 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12195 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012196
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012197sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012198sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12199sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12200sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012201 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12202 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12203 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012204
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012205sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012206sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12207sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12208sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012209 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12210 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12211 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12212 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012213 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012214 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12215
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012216sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012217sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12218sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12219sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012220 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12221 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12222 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12223 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12224 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012225 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012226
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012227sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012228sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12229sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12230sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012231 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12232 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12233 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12234
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012235sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012236sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12237sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12238sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012239 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12240 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012241 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012242 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12243 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012244 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12245 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12246 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012248so_id : integer
12249 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12250 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12251 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012253src : ip
12254 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12255 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12256 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12257 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
12258 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
12259 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
12260 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012261
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012262 Example:
12263 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12264 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012266src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12267 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12268 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12269 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012270 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012272src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12273 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12274 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012275 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012276 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012278src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12279 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12280 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12281 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12282 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12283 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12284 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012285
12286 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12287 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12288 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12289 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012290 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012291 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12292 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012294src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012295 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012296 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012297 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012298 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012300src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012301 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012302 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12303 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012304 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012306src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12307 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12308 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12309 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012310 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012312src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012313 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012314 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012315 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012316 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012317
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012318src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12319 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12320 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
12321 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
12322 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
12323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012324src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012325 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012326 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012327 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
12328 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012329 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12330 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12331 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012333src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12334 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
12335 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012336 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012337 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012338 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012340src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12341 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
12342 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12343 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12344 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012345 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012347src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12348 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12349 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12350 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012351 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012353src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12354 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12355 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12356 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012357 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012358 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012360src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12361 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12362 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12363 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012364 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012365 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
12366 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012367
12368 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012369 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012370 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012372src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012373 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
12374 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
12375 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
12376 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
12377 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012379src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012380 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
12381 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12382 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
12383 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
12384 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012386src_port : integer
12387 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
12388 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
12389 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
12390 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012392src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12393 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012394 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12395 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
12396 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012397 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012399src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12400 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
12401 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12402 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12403 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012404 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012406src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12407 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
12408 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
12409 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
12410 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
12411 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
12412 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
12413 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
12414 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012415
12416 Example :
12417 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
12418 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
12419 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
12420 listen ssh
12421 bind :22
12422 mode tcp
12423 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012424 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012425 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012426 server local 127.0.0.1:22
12427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012428srv_id : integer
12429 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
12430 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
12431 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020012432
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010012433
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200124347.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012435----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020012436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012437The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
12438closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
12439when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
12440usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012441future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012442
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012443ssl_bc : boolean
12444 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12445 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
12446 other a server with the "ssl" option.
12447
12448ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
12449 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
12450 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12451
12452ssl_bc_cipher : string
12453 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
12454 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12455
12456ssl_bc_protocol : string
12457 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
12458 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12459
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012460ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012461 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012462 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12463 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012464
12465ssl_bc_session_id : binary
12466 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
12467 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
12468 if session was reused or not.
12469
12470ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
12471 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
12472 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012474ssl_c_ca_err : integer
12475 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12476 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
12477 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
12478 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
12479 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012481ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
12482 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12483 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
12484 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
12485 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012486
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012487ssl_c_der : binary
12488 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
12489 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12490 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012492ssl_c_err : integer
12493 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12494 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
12495 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
12496 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
12497 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012499ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12500 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12501 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12502 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12503 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12504 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12505 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12506 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12507 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012509ssl_c_key_alg : string
12510 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12511 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12512 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012514ssl_c_notafter : string
12515 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
12516 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12517 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012519ssl_c_notbefore : string
12520 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
12521 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12522 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012524ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12525 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12526 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12527 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12528 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12529 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12530 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12531 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12532 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012534ssl_c_serial : binary
12535 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
12536 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12537 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012539ssl_c_sha1 : binary
12540 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
12541 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
12542 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020012543 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
12544 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
12545
12546 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012548ssl_c_sig_alg : string
12549 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12550 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12551 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012553ssl_c_used : boolean
12554 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
12555 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012557ssl_c_verify : integer
12558 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
12559 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
12560 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
12561 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012563ssl_c_version : integer
12564 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
12565 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012566
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012567ssl_f_der : binary
12568 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
12569 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12570 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012572ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12573 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12574 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12575 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12576 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012577 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012578 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12579 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12580 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012582ssl_f_key_alg : string
12583 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12584 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
12585 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012587ssl_f_notafter : string
12588 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12589 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12590 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012592ssl_f_notbefore : string
12593 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12594 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12595 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012597ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12598 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12599 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12600 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12601 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12602 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12603 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12604 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12605 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012607ssl_f_serial : binary
12608 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12609 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12610 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012611
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020012612ssl_f_sha1 : binary
12613 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
12614 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
12615 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
12616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012617ssl_f_sig_alg : string
12618 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12619 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12620 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012622ssl_f_version : integer
12623 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12624 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12625
12626ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012627 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12628 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
12629 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
12630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012631 Example :
12632 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
12633 listen http-https
12634 bind :80
12635 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
12636 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
12637
12638ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
12639 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
12640 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12641
12642ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012643 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012644 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
12645 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
12646 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
12647 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
12648 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
12649 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
12650 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
12651 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
12652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012653ssl_fc_cipher : string
12654 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
12655 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012657ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012658 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
12659 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010012660 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
12661 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
12662 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
12663 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012665ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
12666 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020012667 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
12668 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
12669 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12670 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012671
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020012672ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
12673 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
12674 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
12675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012676ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012677 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012678 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
12679 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
12680 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
12681 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
12682 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
12683 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
12684 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020012685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012686ssl_fc_protocol : string
12687 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
12688 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012689
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012690ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012691 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012692 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12693 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040012694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012695ssl_fc_session_id : binary
12696 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
12697 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
12698 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
12699 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020012700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012701ssl_fc_sni : string
12702 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
12703 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
12704 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
12705 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
12706 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
12707
12708 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
12709 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
12710 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020012711 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12712 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012714 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012715 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
12716 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020012717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012718ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
12719 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
12720 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012721
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012722
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200127237.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012724------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020012725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012726Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
12727sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
12728only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
12729For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
12730be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
12731can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
12732sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
12733for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
12734content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012736payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
12737 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
12738 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
12739 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012741payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
12742 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
12743 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
12744 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012746req.len : integer
12747req_len : integer (deprecated)
12748 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12749 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12750 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12751 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12752 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12753 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12754 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
12755 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012757req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12758 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012759 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12760 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12761 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12762 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012764 ACL alternatives :
12765 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012767req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12768 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12769 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12770 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
12771 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012773 ACL alternatives :
12774 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012776 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012778req.proto_http : boolean
12779req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
12780 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
12781 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
12782 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
12783 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
12784 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
12785 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
12786 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012788 Example:
12789 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12790 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12791 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012792 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020012793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012794req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
12795rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12796 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
12797 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
12798 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
12799 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
12800 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
12801 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
12802 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012804 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
12805 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
12806 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
12807 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
12808 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
12809 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012811 ACL derivatives :
12812 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012814 Example :
12815 listen tse-farm
12816 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
12817 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
12818 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12819 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
12820 # apply RDP cookie persistence
12821 persist rdp-cookie
12822 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
12823 # This is only useful makes sense if
12824 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
12825 stick-table type string size 204800
12826 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
12827 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
12828 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012830 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12831 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012833req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12834rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12835 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12836 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12837 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12838 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012840 ACL derivatives :
12841 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012842
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020012843req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
12844 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
12845 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
12846 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC certificate
12847 and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that this only
12848 applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to contents
12849 deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines
12850 having the "ssl" option.
12851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012852req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12853req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12854 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12855 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12856 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12857 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12858 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12859 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12860 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012862req.ssl_sni : string
12863req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12864 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12865 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12866 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12867 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12868 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12869 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12870 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12871 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12872 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12873 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12874 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12875 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012877 ACL derivatives :
12878 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012880 Examples :
12881 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12882 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12883 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12884 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12885 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012887res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12888rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12889 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12890 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12891 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12892 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12893 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12894 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12895 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012897req.ssl_ver : integer
12898req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12899 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12900 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12901 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12902 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12903 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12904 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12905 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12906 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12907 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012909 ACL derivatives :
12910 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012911
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012912res.len : integer
12913 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12914 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12915 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12916 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12917 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12918 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12919 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12920 content inspection.
12921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012922res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12923 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012924 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12925 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12926 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12927 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012929res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12930 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12931 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12932 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12933 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012935 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012937wait_end : boolean
12938 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12939 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12940 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12941 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12942 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12943 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12944 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12945 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012947 Examples :
12948 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12949 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12950 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012952 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12953 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12954 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12955 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12956 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12957 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12958 tcp-request content reject
12959
12960
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200129617.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012962--------------------------------------
12963
12964It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12965This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12966data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12967its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12968HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12969content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12970to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12971more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12972response are indexed.
12973
12974base : string
12975 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12976 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12977 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12978 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12979 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12980 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12981 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12982 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12983
12984 ACL derivatives :
12985 base : exact string match
12986 base_beg : prefix match
12987 base_dir : subdir match
12988 base_dom : domain match
12989 base_end : suffix match
12990 base_len : length match
12991 base_reg : regex match
12992 base_sub : substring match
12993
12994base32 : integer
12995 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12996 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12997 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012998 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12999 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13000 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013001
13002base32+src : binary
13003 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13004 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13005 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13006 per-URL counters.
13007
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013008capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13009 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13010 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13011 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13012
13013capture.req.method : string
13014 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13015 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13016 because it's allocated.
13017
13018capture.req.uri : string
13019 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13020 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13021 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13022 allocated.
13023
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013024capture.req.ver : string
13025 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13026 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13027 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13028
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013029capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13030 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13031 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13032 The first entry is an index of 0.
13033 See also: "capture response header"
13034
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013035capture.res.ver : string
13036 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13037 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13038 persistent flag.
13039
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013040req.body : binary
13041 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13042 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13043 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13044 the first chunk is analyzed.
13045
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013046req.body_param([<name>) : string
13047 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13048 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13049 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13050 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13051 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13052 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13053 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13054 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13055 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13056 given.
13057
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013058req.body_len : integer
13059 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13060 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13061 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13062 "option http-buffer-request".
13063
13064req.body_size : integer
13065 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13066 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13067 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13068 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13069 "option http-buffer-request".
13070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013071req.cook([<name>]) : string
13072cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13073 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13074 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13075 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13076 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13077 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13078 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13079 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13080 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13081
13082 ACL derivatives :
13083 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13084 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13085 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13086 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13087 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13088 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13089 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13090 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013092req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13093cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13094 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13095 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013097req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13098cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13099 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13100 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13101 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13102 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013104cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13105 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13106 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13107 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13108 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013109 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013110 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13111 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13112 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13113 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013115hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13116 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13117 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13118 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13119 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013120 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013122req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13123 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13124 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13125 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13126 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13127 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13128 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13129 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13130 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013132req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13133 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13134 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13135 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13136 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013138req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13139 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13140 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13141 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13142 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13143 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13144 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13145 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13146 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13147 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13148 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13149 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013151 ACL derivatives :
13152 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13153 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13154 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13155 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13156 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13157 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13158 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13159 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13160
13161req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13162hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13163 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13164 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13165 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13166 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13167 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13168 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13169 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13170 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13171 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13172
13173req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13174hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13175 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13176 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13177 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13178 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13179 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13180 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13181 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13182 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13183
13184req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13185hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13186 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13187 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13188 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13189 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13190 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13191 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13192 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13193
13194http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13195 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13196 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13197 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13198 basic auth is supported.
13199
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013200http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13201 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13202 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13203 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13204 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013205 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13206 basic auth is supported.
13207
13208 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013209 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13210 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13211 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13212 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013213
13214http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013215 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13216 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013217 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13218 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013220method : integer + string
13221 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
13222 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
13223 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
13224 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
13225 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
13226 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
13227 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013229 ACL derivatives :
13230 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013232 Example :
13233 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13234 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13235 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013237path : string
13238 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13239 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13240 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13241 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13242 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13243 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13244 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013246 ACL derivatives :
13247 path : exact string match
13248 path_beg : prefix match
13249 path_dir : subdir match
13250 path_dom : domain match
13251 path_end : suffix match
13252 path_len : length match
13253 path_reg : regex match
13254 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013255
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013256query : string
13257 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13258 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13259 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13260 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13261 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13262 which stops before the question mark.
13263
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013264req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13265 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13266 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13267 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13268 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013270req.ver : string
13271req_ver : string (deprecated)
13272 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13273 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13274 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013276 ACL derivatives :
13277 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013279res.comp : boolean
13280 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13281 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13282 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013284res.comp_algo : string
13285 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13286 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13287 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013289res.cook([<name>]) : string
13290scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13291 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13292 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13293 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013295 ACL derivatives :
13296 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013298res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13299scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13300 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13301 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13302 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013304res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13305scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13306 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13307 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13308 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013310res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13311 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13312 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13313 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13314 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13315 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
13316 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
13317 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
13318 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
13319 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013321res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13322 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13323 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13324 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13325 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
13326 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013328res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13329shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
13330 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13331 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13332 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13333 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13334 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
13335 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
13336 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
13337 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013339 ACL derivatives :
13340 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13341 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13342 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13343 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13344 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13345 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13346 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13347 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13348
13349res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13350shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13351 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13352 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13353 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
13354 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
13355 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013357res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13358shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13359 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
13360 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
13361 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
13362 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
13363 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
13364 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013365
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013366res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13367 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13368 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13369 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13370 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013372res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13373shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13374 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
13375 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13376 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13377 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13378 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
13379 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013381res.ver : string
13382resp_ver : string (deprecated)
13383 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
13384 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013386 ACL derivatives :
13387 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013389set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13390 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13391 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013392 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013393 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013395 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
13396 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013398status : integer
13399 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
13400 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
13401 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013403url : string
13404 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
13405 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
13406 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
13407 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
13408 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
13409 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
13410 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013412 ACL derivatives :
13413 url : exact string match
13414 url_beg : prefix match
13415 url_dir : subdir match
13416 url_dom : domain match
13417 url_end : suffix match
13418 url_len : length match
13419 url_reg : regex match
13420 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013422url_ip : ip
13423 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
13424 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
13425 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
13426 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
13427 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
13428 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13429 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013431url_port : integer
13432 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
13433 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
13434 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13435 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013436
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013437urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
13438url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013439 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
13440 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013441 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
13442 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
13443 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
13444 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013445 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
13446 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013447 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
13448 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013450 ACL derivatives :
13451 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
13452 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
13453 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
13454 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
13455 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
13456 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
13457 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
13458 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013459
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013461 Example :
13462 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
13463 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
13464 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
13465 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013466
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013467urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013468 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
13469 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
13470 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020013471
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010013472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200134737.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013474---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013476Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
13477every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013478order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013480ACL name Equivalent to Usage
13481---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013482FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020013483HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013484HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
13485HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013486HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
13487HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
13488HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
13489HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
13490LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013491METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
13492METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
13493METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
13494METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
13495METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
13496METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013497RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013498REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013499TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013500WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
13501---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013502
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010013503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135048. Logging
13505----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013506
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013507One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
13508provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
13509very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
13510provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
13511state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013512to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013513headers.
13514
13515In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
13516about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
13517send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
13518
13519 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
13520 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
13521 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
13522 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
13523 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060013524 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
13525 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013526
13527The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
13528allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
13529as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
13530while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
13531real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
13532delay.
13533
13534
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135358.1. Log levels
13536---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013537
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013538TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013539source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013540HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
13541in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
13542track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
13543syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
13544about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013545
13546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135478.2. Log formats
13548----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013549
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013550HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013551and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
13552slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
13553options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013554
13555 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
13556 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
13557 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
13558 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
13559 extents.
13560
13561 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
13562 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
13563 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
13564 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
13565 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
13566
13567 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
13568 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
13569 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
13570 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
13571 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
13572
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020013573 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
13574 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
13575 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
13576 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
13577
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013578 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
13579
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013580Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
13581specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
13582field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
13583servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
13584always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
13585identifier.
13586
13587Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
13588 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
13589 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
13590 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
13591 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
13592
13593
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135948.2.1. Default log format
13595-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013596
13597This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
13598as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
13599format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
13600
13601 Example :
13602 listen www
13603 mode http
13604 log global
13605 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13606
13607 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
13608 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
13609 (www/HTTP)
13610
13611 Field Format Extract from the example above
13612 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
13613 2 'Connect from' Connect from
13614 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
13615 4 'to' to
13616 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
13617 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
13618
13619Detailed fields description :
13620 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
13621 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
13622 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
13623 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
13624 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13625 and processed the connection.
13626 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
13627
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013628In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
13629"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
13630connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
13631
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013632It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
13633will eventually disappear.
13634
13635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136368.2.2. TCP log format
13637---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013638
13639The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
13640is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
13641information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
13642counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
13643emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
13644environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
13645the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
13646sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013647specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
13648not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
13649fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
13650marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013651
13652 Example :
13653 frontend fnt
13654 mode tcp
13655 option tcplog
13656 log global
13657 default_backend bck
13658
13659 backend bck
13660 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13661
13662 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
13663 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
13664 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
13665
13666 Field Format Extract from the example above
13667 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
13668 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
13669 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
13670 4 frontend_name fnt
13671 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
13672 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
13673 7 bytes_read* 212
13674 8 termination_state --
13675 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
13676 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13677
13678Detailed fields description :
13679 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013680 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13681 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13682 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13683 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13684 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013685
13686 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013687 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13688 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13689 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013690
13691 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
13692 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
13693 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
13694 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
13695
13696 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13697 and processed the connection.
13698
13699 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13700 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13701 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
13702 applications.
13703
13704 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13705 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13706 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13707 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
13708 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
13709
13710 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13711 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13712 See "Timers" below for more details.
13713
13714 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13715 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13716 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
13717 "Timers" below for more details.
13718
13719 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013720 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013721 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13722 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13723 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13724 details.
13725
13726 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
13727 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
13728 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
13729 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
13730 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
13731
13732 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13733 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13734 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
13735 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
13736 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
13737 for more details.
13738
13739 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013740 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013741 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
13742 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
13743 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013744 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013745
13746 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13747 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13748 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13749 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13750 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13751 caused by a denial of service attack.
13752
13753 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13754 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13755 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13756 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13757 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13758 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13759 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13760 denial of service attack.
13761
13762 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13763 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13764 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13765 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13766 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13767 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13768 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13769 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
13770 be processed than on other servers.
13771
13772 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13773 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13774 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13775 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13776 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13777 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13778 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13779 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13780 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13781 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13782 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13783 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13784 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13785
13786 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13787 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13788 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13789 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13790 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13791 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13792 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13793 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13794
13795 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13796 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13797 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13798 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13799 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13800 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13801 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13802 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13803 occurs.
13804
13805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138068.2.3. HTTP log format
13807----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013808
13809The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
13810is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
13811the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
13812are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
13813emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
13814generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
13815"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
13816which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013817frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
13818is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013819
13820Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
13821slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
13822with a star ('*') after the field name below.
13823
13824 Example :
13825 frontend http-in
13826 mode http
13827 option httplog
13828 log global
13829 default_backend bck
13830
13831 backend static
13832 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13833
13834 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
13835 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
13836 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013837 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013838
13839 Field Format Extract from the example above
13840 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
13841 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
13842 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
13843 4 frontend_name http-in
13844 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
13845 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
13846 7 status_code 200
13847 8 bytes_read* 2750
13848 9 captured_request_cookie -
13849 10 captured_response_cookie -
13850 11 termination_state ----
13851 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
13852 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13853 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
13854 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
13855 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013856
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013857
13858Detailed fields description :
13859 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013860 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13861 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13862 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13863 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13864 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013865
13866 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013867 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13868 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13869 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013870
13871 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13872 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13873 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13874 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13875 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13876
13877 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13878 and processed the connection.
13879
13880 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13881 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13882 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13883
13884 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13885 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13886 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13887 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13888 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13889 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13890
13891 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13892 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13893 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13894 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13895 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13896 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13897
13898 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13899 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13900 See "Timers" below for more details.
13901
13902 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13903 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13904 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13905 below for more details.
13906
13907 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13908 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13909 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13910 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13911 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13912 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13913 for more details.
13914
13915 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013916 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013917 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13918 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13919 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13920 details.
13921
13922 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13923 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13924 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13925
13926 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13927 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13928 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13929 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13930 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13931 overflowing.
13932
13933 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13934 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13935 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13936 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13937 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13938 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13939 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13940 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13941
13942 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13943 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13944 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13945 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13946 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13947 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13948 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13949 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13950
13951 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13952 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13953 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13954 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13955 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13956 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13957 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13958
13959 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013960 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013961 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13962 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13963 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013964 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013965 system.
13966
13967 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13968 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13969 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13970 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13971 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13972 caused by a denial of service attack.
13973
13974 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13975 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13976 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13977 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13978 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13979 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13980 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13981 denial of service attack.
13982
13983 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13984 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13985 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13986 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13987 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13988 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13989 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13990 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13991 processed than on other servers.
13992
13993 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13994 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13995 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13996 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13997 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13998 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13999 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14000 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14001 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14002 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14003 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14004 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14005 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14006
14007 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14008 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14009 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14010 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14011 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14012 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14013 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14014 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14015
14016 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14017 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14018 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14019 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14020 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14021 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14022 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14023 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14024 occurs.
14025
14026 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14027 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14028 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14029 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14030 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14031 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14032 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14033 cookies" below for more details.
14034
14035 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14036 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14037 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14038 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14039 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14040 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14041 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14042 and cookies" below for more details.
14043
14044 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14045 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14046 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14047 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14048 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14049 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14050 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14051 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14052
14053
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200140548.2.4. Custom log format
14055------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014056
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014057The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014058mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014059
14060HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14061Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14062separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14063prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14064
14065Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14066variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
14067string formats ("Q").
14068
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014069If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014070as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014071less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14072the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14073
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014074Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014075In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014076in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014077
14078Flags are :
14079 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014080 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014081
14082 Example:
14083
14084 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14085 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14086
14087At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14088
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014089 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
14090 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014091
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014092the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014093
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014094 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014095 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014096 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014097
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014098and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14099
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014100 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014101 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
14102
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014103Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14104
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014105 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014106 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014107 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14108 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14109 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014110 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14111 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14112 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014113 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014114 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14115 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014116 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014117 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14118 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014119 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014120 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014121 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014122 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014123 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014124 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
14125 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014126 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014127 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14128 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014129 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014130 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14131 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014132 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14133 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14134 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014135 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014136 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14137 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014138 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014139 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14140 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14141 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014142 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014143 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014144 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14145 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14146 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14147 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020014148 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014149 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014150 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014151 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014152 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014153 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014154 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14155 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14156 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014157 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014158 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14159 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014160 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014161 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014162 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014163 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014164
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014165 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014166
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014167
141688.2.5. Error log format
14169-----------------------
14170
14171When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14172protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14173By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14174"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14175will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14176logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14177
14178The format looks like this :
14179
14180 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
14181 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
14182 Connection error during SSL handshake
14183
14184 Field Format Extract from the example above
14185 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
14186 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
14187 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
14188 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
14189 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
14190
14191These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
14192failures.
14193
14194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141958.3. Advanced logging options
14196-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014197
14198Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
14199just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
14200options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
14201for more information about their usage.
14202
14203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
14205------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014206
14207It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
14208haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
14209commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
14210monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
14211ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
14212
14213 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
14214 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
14215 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
14216 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
14217
14218 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
14219 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
14220 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014221 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014222 such as other load-balancers.
14223
14224 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
14225 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
14226 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
14227
14228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142298.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
14230----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014231
14232The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14233what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14234or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14235"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14236just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14237log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14238after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14239is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14240with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14241with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14242
14243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142448.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14245------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014246
14247Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14248for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14249"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14250retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14251raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14252a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14253file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14254you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14255"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14256
14257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142588.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14259--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014260
14261Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14262multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14263them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14264"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14265logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14266error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14267and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14268too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14269useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14270alternative.
14271
14272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142738.4. Timing events
14274------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014275
14276Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14277reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14278the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14279frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
14280mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
14281
14282 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
14283 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
14284 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
14285 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
14286 the client closes prematurely or times out.
14287
14288 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
14289 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
14290 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
14291 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
14292 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
14293
14294 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
14295 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
14296 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
14297 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
14298 connection never established.
14299
14300 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
14301 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
14302 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
14303 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
14304 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
14305 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
14306 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
14307 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
14308 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
14309 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
14310 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
14311
14312 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
14313 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
14314 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
14315 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014316 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014317
14318 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
14319
14320 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
14321 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
14322 negative.
14323
14324These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
14325protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
14326that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014327due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014328close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
14329session has been aborted on timeout.
14330
14331Most common cases :
14332
14333 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14334 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
14335 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
14336 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
14337 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
14338 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
14339 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
14340 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
14341 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020014342 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
14343 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
14344 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014345
14346 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14347 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
14348 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
14349 of ms on remote networks.
14350
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014351 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
14352 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
14353 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014354
14355 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
14356 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
14357 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
14358 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
14359 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
14360 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
14361 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
14362 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
14363 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
14364 to the server until another one is released.
14365
14366Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
14367
14368 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
14369 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
14370 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
14371
14372 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
14373 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
14374 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
14375
14376 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
14377 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
14378 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
14379 flags.
14380
14381 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
14382 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
14383 Check the session termination flags, then check the
14384 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
14385 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
14386 the client connection was maintained open.
14387
14388 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014389 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014390 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
14391 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
14392
14393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143948.5. Session state at disconnection
14395-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014396
14397TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
14398"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
143992-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
14400each of which has a special meaning :
14401
14402 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
14403 session to terminate :
14404
14405 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
14406
14407 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
14408 server explicitly refused it.
14409
14410 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
14411 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
14412 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
14413 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014414 (eg: cacheable cookie).
14415
14416 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
14417 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014418
14419 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
14420 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
14421 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
14422 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
14423 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
14424
14425 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
14426 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
14427 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
14428 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
14429 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
14430
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090014431 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
14432 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
14433
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014434 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
14435 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
14436 backup connections when going up.
14437
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020014438 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
14439
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014440 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
14441 send or receive data.
14442
14443 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
14444 send or receive data.
14445
14446 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
14447 with nothing left in the buffers.
14448
14449 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
14450
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010014451 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014452 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
14453
14454 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
14455 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
14456 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
14457 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
14458 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
14459
14460 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
14461 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
14462
14463 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
14464 server (HTTP only).
14465
14466 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
14467
14468 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
14469 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
14470 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
14471
14472 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
14473 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
14474 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
14475
14476 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
14477
14478 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
14479 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
14480
14481 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
14482 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
14483 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
14484
14485 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
14486 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020014487 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
14488 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014489
14490 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
14491 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
14492 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
14493 another server.
14494
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014495 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014496 server.
14497
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014498 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
14499 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
14500 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
14501 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14502
14503 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
14504 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
14505 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
14506 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14507
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020014508 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
14509 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
14510 "use-server" rule).
14511
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014512 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14513
14514 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
14515 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
14516
14517 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
14518
14519 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
14520 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
14521 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
14522
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014523 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
14524 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014525 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014526 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
14527 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
14528
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014529 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
14530
14531 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
14532 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
14533
14534 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
14535
14536 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14537
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014538The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
14539was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014540helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
14541starvation, attacks, etc...
14542
14543The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
14544alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
14545easier finding and understanding.
14546
14547 Flags Reason
14548
14549 -- Normal termination.
14550
14551 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
14552 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
14553 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
14554 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
14555
14556 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
14557 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
14558 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
14559 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
14560 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
14561 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014562
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014563 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14564 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014565 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014566
14567 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
14568 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
14569 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
14570
14571 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
14572 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
14573 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
14574 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
14575 the server takes too long to respond.
14576
14577 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
14578 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
14579 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
14580 long a time to respond.
14581
14582 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
14583 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
14584 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
14585 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014586 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
14587 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014588
14589 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
14590 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
14591 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
14592 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
14593 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014594 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014595 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
14596 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
14597 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
14598 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
14599 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
14600 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
14601 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
14602 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
14603 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
14604 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
14605 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
14606 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014607
14608 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
14609 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014610 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
14611 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
14612 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
14613 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014614
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014615 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
14616 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
14617
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014618 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014619 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
14620 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
14621 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
14622 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
14623 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
14624
14625 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
14626 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
14627 503 or 504 here.
14628
14629 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
14630 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
14631 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
14632 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
14633 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
14634
14635 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14636 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014637 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014638 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
14639 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
14640
14641 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
14642 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
14643 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
14644 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
14645 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
14646 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
14647 between haproxy and the server.
14648
14649 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
14650 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
14651 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
14652 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
14653 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
14654 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
14655 solution is to fix the application.
14656
14657 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
14658 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
14659 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
14660 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
14661 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
14662 external attacks.
14663
14664 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
14665 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014666 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014667 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
14668 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
14669
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014670 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
14671 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
14672 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020014673 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
14674 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014675
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014676 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
14677 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
14678 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
14679 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010014680 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
14681 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
14682 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
14683 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
14684 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014685
14686 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
14687 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
14688 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
14689 returned an HTTP 403 error.
14690
14691 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
14692 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
14693 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
14694 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
14695
14696 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
14697 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
14698 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
14699 only be solved by proper system tuning.
14700
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014701The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
14702persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
14703important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
14704re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
14705
14706 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
14707
14708 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14709 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
14710 set on a GET request.
14711
14712 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
14713 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014714 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014715 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
14716
14717 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
14718 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
14719 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
14720
14721 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
14722 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
14723 already got a cookie.
14724
14725 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14726 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
14727 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
14728 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
14729 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
14730
14731 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
14732 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14733 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14734
14735 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
14736 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
14737 new cookie was inserted in the response.
14738
14739 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
14740 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
14741
14742 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
14743 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
14744 then advertised in the response.
14745
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014746
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147478.6. Non-printable characters
14748-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014749
14750In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
14751consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
14752converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
14753prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
14754being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
14755escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
14756is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
14757'}' when logging headers.
14758
14759Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
14760issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
14761containing spaces is "User-Agent".
14762
14763Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
14764the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
14765performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
14766
14767
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147688.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
14769---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014770
14771Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
14772achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014773section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014774cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
14775the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
14776the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014777locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014778not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
14779user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
14780a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
14781wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
14782
14783 Examples :
14784 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
14785 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
14786
14787 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
14788 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
14789
14790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
14792---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014793
14794Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
14795proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
14796the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
14797server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
14798
14799Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
14800response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014801section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014802
14803It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014804time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
14805appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014806are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
14807and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
14808follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
14809request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
14810in the logs.
14811
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014812As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
14813frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
14814an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
14815
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014816 Example :
14817 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
14818 listen proxy-out
14819 mode http
14820 option httplog
14821 option logasap
14822 log global
14823 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
14824
14825 # log the name of the virtual server
14826 capture request header Host len 20
14827
14828 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
14829 capture request header Content-Length len 10
14830
14831 # log the beginning of the referrer
14832 capture request header Referer len 20
14833
14834 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
14835 capture response header Server len 20
14836
14837 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
14838 capture response header Content-Length len 10
14839
14840 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
14841 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
14842
14843 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
14844 capture response header Via len 20
14845
14846 # log the URL location during a redirection
14847 capture response header Location len 20
14848
14849 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
14850 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
14851 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14852 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
14853 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
14854
14855 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14856 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14857 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14858 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014859 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014860
14861 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14862 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14863 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14864 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
14865 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014866 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014867
14868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148698.9. Examples of logs
14870---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014871
14872These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14873them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14874reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14875
14876 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14877 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14878 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14879
14880 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14881 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14882
14883 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14884 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14885 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14886
14887 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14888 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14889
14890 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14891 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14892 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14893
14894 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014895 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014896 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14897 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14898
14899 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14900 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14901 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14902
14903 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14904 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014905 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014906 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14907 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14908 to return the 502 and not the server.
14909
14910 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014911 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014912
14913 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14914 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14915 Nothing was sent to any server.
14916
14917 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14918 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14919
14920 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14921 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14922 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14923 send a 408 return code to the client.
14924
14925 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14926 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14927
14928 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14929 5 seconds ("c----").
14930
14931 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14932 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014933 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014934
14935 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014936 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014937 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14938 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14939 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14940 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14941 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014942
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149449. Statistics and monitoring
14945----------------------------
14946
14947It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14948mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14949CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14950Unix socket.
14951
14952
149539.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014954---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014955
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014956The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014957page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14958begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14959represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14960use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14961('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14962(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14963text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14964do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14965use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014966
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014967In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14968that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14969S (Servers).
14970
14971 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14972 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14973 any name for server/listener)
14974 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14975 number queued without a server assigned.
14976 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14977 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14978 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14979 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14980 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14981 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14982 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14983 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14984 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14985 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14986 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14987 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14988 "option checkcache".
14989 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14990 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14991 - read error from the client
14992 - client timeout
14993 - client closed connection
14994 - various bad requests from the client.
14995 - request was tarpitted.
14996 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14997 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14998 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14999 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
15000 active servers).
15001 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
15002 Some other errors are:
15003 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
15004 - failure applying filters to the response.
15005 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
15006 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
15007 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
15008 switched away from.
15009 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissis1f673c72015-05-02 20:30:44 +020015010 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
15011 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
15012 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040015013 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
15014 the server is up.)
15015 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
15016 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
15017 counters for each server.
15018 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
15019 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
15020 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
15021 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
15022 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
15023 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
15024 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
15025 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
15026 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
15027 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
15028 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
15029 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
15030 of times that server was selected.
15031 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
15032 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
15033 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
15034 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
15035 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
15036 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015037 UNK -> unknown
15038 INI -> initializing
15039 SOCKERR -> socket error
15040 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080015041 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015042 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
15043 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
15044 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
15045 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
15046 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
15047 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
15048 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
15049 disable-on-404
15050 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
15051 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
15052 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040015053 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
15054 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
15055 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
15056 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
15057 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
15058 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
15059 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
15060 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
15061 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
15062 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
15063 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
15064 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
15065 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
15066 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
15067 (inc. in eresp)
15068 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
15069 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
15070 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
15071 (CPU/BW limit)
15072 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
15073 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
15074 server/backend
15075 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
15076 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
15077 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
15078 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
15079 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
15080 (0 for TCP)
15081 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
15082 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015083
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150859.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015086-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015087
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020015088The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
15089necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
15090A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
15091issuing commands by hand :
15092
15093 global
15094 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
15095 stats timeout 2m
15096
15097It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
15098the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
15099never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
15100situations :
15101
15102 global
15103 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
15104 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
15105 stats timeout 2m
15106
15107To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
15108swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
15109to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
15110syntaxes we'll use are the following :
15111
15112 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
15113 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
15114
15115The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
15116script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
15117for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
15118
15119The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
15120that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
15121editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
15122(eg: watch a counter).
15123
15124The socket supports two operation modes :
15125 - interactive
15126 - non-interactive
15127
15128The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
15129this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
15130sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
15131mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
15132commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
15133example :
15134
15135 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
15136
15137The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
15138entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
15139for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
15140sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
15141"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
15142after processing the last command of the same line.
15143
15144For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
15145"prompt" command :
15146
15147 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
15148 prompt
15149 > show info
15150 ...
15151 >
15152
15153Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
15154delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
15155that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
15156parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015157
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015158It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
15159on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
15160own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015161
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020015162The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
15163If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
15164all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
15165it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
15166
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015167add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015168 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
15169 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
15170 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
15171 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015172
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015173add map <map> <key> <value>
15174 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
15175 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015176 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
15177 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
15178 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015179
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015180clear counters
15181 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
15182 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
15183 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
15184 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
15185 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15186
15187clear counters all
15188 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
15189 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
15190 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
15191
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015192clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015193 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
15194 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
15195 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015196
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015197clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015198 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
15199 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
15200 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015201
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015202clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
15203 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
15204
15205 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
15206 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
15207 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
15208 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
15209 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
15210 later after the session ends is usual enough.
15211
15212 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
15213
15214 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
15215 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
15216 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
15217 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
15218 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
15219 the ACLs :
15220
15221 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15222 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15223 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15224 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15225 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15226 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15227
15228 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015229 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
15230 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015231
15232 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015233 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020015234 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015235 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15236 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15237 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15238 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015239
15240 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15241
15242 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020015243 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015244 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15245 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015246 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15247 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15248 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015249
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015250del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
15251 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015252 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
15253 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15254 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
15255 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015256
15257del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015258 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015259 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
15260 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15261 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
15262 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015263
15264disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015265 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
15266
15267 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
15268 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
15269 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
15270 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
15271 re-enabled using enable agent.
15272
15273 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
15274 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
15275 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
15276 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
15277 otherwise unchanged.
15278
15279 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
15280 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
15281 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
15282
15283 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15284 level "admin".
15285
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015286disable frontend <frontend>
15287 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
15288 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
15289 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
15290 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
15291 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
15292 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
15293 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
15294 on the stats page.
15295
15296 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15297 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15298
15299 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15300 level "admin".
15301
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015302disable health <backend>/<server>
15303 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
15304 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
15305 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
15306 agent check forces it down.
15307
15308 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15309 level "admin".
15310
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015311disable server <backend>/<server>
15312 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
15313 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
15314 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
15315 during the maintenance.
15316
15317 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
15318 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
15319
15320 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015321 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015322
15323 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15324 level "admin".
15325
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015326enable agent <backend>/<server>
15327 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
15328
15329 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
15330 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
15331
15332 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15333 level "admin".
15334
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015335enable frontend <frontend>
15336 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
15337 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
15338 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
15339 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
15340 which was disabled.
15341
15342 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15343 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15344
15345 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15346 level "admin".
15347
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015348enable health <backend>/<server>
15349 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
15350 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
15351
15352 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15353 level "admin".
15354
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015355enable server <backend>/<server>
15356 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
15357 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
15358
15359 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015360 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015361
15362 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15363 level "admin".
15364
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015365get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015366get acl <acl> <value>
15367 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
15368 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
15369 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
15370 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
15371 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015372
15373 The first two words are:
15374
15375 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
15376 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
15377 "dom", "end" or "reg".
15378
15379 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
15380
15381 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
15382
15383 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
15384
15385 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
15386 interpretation of the case.
15387
15388 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
15389 useful with regular expressions.
15390
15391 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
15392 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
15393
15394 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
15395 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
15396 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
15397
15398 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
15399
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015400get weight <backend>/<server>
15401 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
15402 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
15403 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
15404 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
15405 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015406 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015407
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015408help
15409 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
15410 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015411
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015412prompt
15413 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
15414 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
15415 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
15416 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
15417 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
15418 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
15419 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
15420 command.
15421
15422quit
15423 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015424
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015425set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015426 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
15427 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
15428 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015429
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015430set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020015431 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
15432 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
15433 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
15434 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
15435 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015436 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
15437 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15438
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020015439set maxconn global <maxconn>
15440 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
15441 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
15442 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
15443 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
15444 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
15445 setting.
15446
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020015447set rate-limit connections global <value>
15448 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
15449 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15450 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15451 is passed in number of connections per second.
15452
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015453set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
15454 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
15455 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010015456 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
15457 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015458
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020015459set rate-limit sessions global <value>
15460 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
15461 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15462 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15463 is passed in number of sessions per second.
15464
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020015465set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
15466 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
15467 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15468 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15469 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
15470 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
15471
Baptiste Assmann3d8f8312015-04-13 22:54:33 +020015472set server <backend>/<server> addr <ip4 or ip6 address>
15473 Replace the current IP address of a server by the one provided.
15474
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020015475set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
15476 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15477 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
15478 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15479
15480set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
15481 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15482 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
15483 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15484
15485set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
15486 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
15487 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
15488 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
15489 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
15490 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
15491 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
15492 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
15493 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
15494
15495set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
15496 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
15497 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
15498
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015499set ssl ocsp-response <response>
15500 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
15501 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
15502 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
15503 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
15504
15505 Example:
15506 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
15507 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
15508 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
15509 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
15510
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015511set ssl tls-key <id> <tlskey>
15512 Set the next TLS key for the <id> listener to <tlskey>. This key becomes the
15513 ultimate key, while the penultimate one is used for encryption (others just
15514 decrypt). The oldest TLS key present is overwritten. <id> is either a numeric
15515 #<id> or <file> returned by "show tls-keys". <tlskey> is a base64 encoded 48
15516 bit TLS ticket key (ex. openssl rand -base64 48).
15517
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015518set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015519 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
15520 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
15521 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
15522 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015523 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
15524 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015525
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015526set timeout cli <delay>
15527 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
15528 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
15529 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
15530
15531set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
15532 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
15533 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090015534 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
15535 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
15536 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
15537 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
15538 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
15539 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
15540 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
15541 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
15542 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
15543 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
15544 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
15545 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
15546 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015547
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015548show errors [<iid>]
15549 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
15550 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015551 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
15552 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
15553 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015554
15555 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
15556 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
15557 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
15558 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
15559 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
15560 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
15561 are reported too.
15562
15563 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
15564 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
15565 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
15566 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
15567 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
15568 code.
15569
15570 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
15571 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
15572 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
15573 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
15574 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
15575 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
15576 line.
15577
15578 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015579 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15580 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015581 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
15582 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
15583
15584 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
15585 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
15586 00038 Location: blah\r\n
15587 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
15588 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
15589 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
15590 00204+ minal\r\n
15591 00211 \r\n
15592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015593 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015594 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
15595 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
15596 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
15597 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
15598 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
15599 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015600
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015601show info
15602 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
15603
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015604show map [<map>]
15605 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015606 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
15607 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
15608 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
15609 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
15610 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
15611 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015612
15613show acl [<acl>]
15614 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015615 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
15616 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
15617 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
15618 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
15619 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015620
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010015621show pools
15622 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
15623 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
15624 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
15625 the pools.
15626
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015627show sess
15628 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015629 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
15630 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15631
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010015632show sess <id>
15633 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
15634 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15635 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
15636 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
15637 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020015638 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
15639 returned in src/dumpstats.c
15640
15641 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
15642 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015643
15644show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
15645 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
15646 possible to dump only selected items :
15647 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
15648 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
15649 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
15650 for example:
15651 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
15652 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
15653 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
15654
15655 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015656 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
15657 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015658 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
15659 Release_date: 2009/09/23
15660 Nbproc: 1
15661 Process_num: 1
15662 (...)
15663
15664 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
15665 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
15666 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
15667 (...)
15668 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
15669
15670 $
15671
15672 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
15673 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
15674 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
15675 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015676 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015677
Baptiste Assmann3863f972015-05-17 00:33:24 +020015678show stat resolvers <resolvers section id>
15679 Dump statistics for the given resolvers section.
15680 For each name server, the following counters are reported:
15681 sent: number of DNS requests sent to this server
15682 valid: number of DNS valid responses received from this server
15683 update: number of DNS responses used to update the server's IP address
15684 cname: number of CNAME responses
15685 cname_error: CNAME errors encountered with this server
15686 any_err: number of empty response (IE: server does not support ANY type)
15687 nx: non existent domain response received from this server
15688 timeout: how many time this server did not answer in time
15689 refused: number of requests refused by this server
15690 other: any other DNS errors
15691 invalid: invalid DNS response (from a protocol point of view)
15692 too_big: too big response
15693 outdated: number of response arrived too late (after an other name server)
15694
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015695show table
15696 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
15697 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
15698 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
15699 entries currently in use.
15700
15701 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015702 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015703 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
15704 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015705
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015706show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015707 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
15708 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
15709 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015710 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
15711
15712 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
15713 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
15714 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
15715 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
15716 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
15717
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015718 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15719 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15720 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15721 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15722 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15723 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15724
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015725
15726 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015727 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
15728 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015729
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015730 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015731 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015732 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015733 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15734 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15735 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15736 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015737
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015738 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015739 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015740 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15741 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015742
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015743 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
15744 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015745 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015746 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15747 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015748
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015749 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
15750 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090015751 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090015752 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15753 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
15754
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015755 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
15756 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
15757 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
15758 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
15759 time goes, the average event rate drops.
15760
15761 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
15762 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
15763 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015764 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
15765 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015766 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
15767 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020015768
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015769show tls-keys
15770 Dump all loaded TLS ticket keys. The TLS ticket key reference ID and the
15771 file from which the keys have been loaded is shown. Both of those can be
15772 used to update the TLS keys using "set ssl tls-key".
15773
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015774shutdown frontend <frontend>
15775 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
15776 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
15777 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
15778 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
15779 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
15780 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
15781 once it is terminated.
15782
15783 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15784 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15785
15786 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15787 level "admin".
15788
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020015789shutdown session <id>
15790 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
15791 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
15792 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
15793 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
15794 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
15795 flag in the logs.
15796
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020015797shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015798 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
15799 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
15800 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
15801 'K' flag in the logs.
15802
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015803/*
15804 * Local variables:
15805 * fill-column: 79
15806 * End:
15807 */